]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/gcc.git/blame - gcc/doc/tm.texi.in
update darwin to use link_gcc_c_sequence.
[thirdparty/gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi.in
CommitLineData
38f8b050
JR
1@c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,
2@c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
3@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4@c This is part of the GCC manual.
5@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
6
7@node Target Macros
8@chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
9@cindex machine description macros
10@cindex target description macros
11@cindex macros, target description
12@cindex @file{tm.h} macros
13
14In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
15includes a C header file conventionally given the name
16@file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
17The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
18about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
19@file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
20@file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
21@file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
22source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
23containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
24machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
25if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
26through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
27
28@menu
29* Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
30* Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
31* Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
32* Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
33* Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
34* Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
35* Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36* Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
37* Old Constraints:: The old way to define machine-specific constraints.
38* Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
39* Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
40* Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
41* Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
42* Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
43* Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
44* Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
45* Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
46* Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
47* Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
48* PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
49* Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
50* Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
51* Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
52* Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
53* Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
54* Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
55* MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
56* PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
57* C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
58* Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
59* Misc:: Everything else.
60@end menu
61
62@node Target Structure
63@section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
64@cindex target hooks
65@cindex target functions
66
67@deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
68The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
69which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
70machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
71@file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
72used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
73for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
74macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
75@smallexample
76#include "target.h"
77#include "target-def.h"
78
79/* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
80
81#undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
82#define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
83
84struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
85@end smallexample
86@end deftypevar
87
88Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
89form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
90``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
91from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
92@code{targetm} structure.
93
94@node Driver
95@section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
96@cindex driver
97@cindex controlling the compilation driver
98
99@c prevent bad page break with this line
100You can control the compilation driver.
101
38f8b050
JR
102@defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
103A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
104initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
105
106The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
107default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
108choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
109applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
110options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
111using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
112
113This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
114options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
115that the other specs are easier to write.
116
117Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
118@end defmac
119
120@defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
121A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
122@option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
123for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
124outermost pair of surrounding braces.
125
126The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
127the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
128to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
129@samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
130everywhere it occurs.
131
132The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
133default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
134the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
135
136Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
137@end defmac
138
139@defmac CPP_SPEC
140A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
141pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
142give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
143
144Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
145@end defmac
146
147@defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
148This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
149than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
150@code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
151@end defmac
152
153@defmac CC1_SPEC
154A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
155pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
156front ends.
157It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
158for GCC to pass to front ends.
159
160Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
161@end defmac
162
163@defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
164A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
165pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
166give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
167
168Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
169Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
170@code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
171CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
172@end defmac
173
174@defmac ASM_SPEC
175A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
176pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
177you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
178See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
179
180Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
181@end defmac
182
183@defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
184A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
185run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
186Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
187an example of this.
188
189Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
190@end defmac
191
192@defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
193Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
194an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
195read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
196output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
197@option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
198
199If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
200standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
201cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
202see @file{mips.h} for instance.
203@end defmac
204
205@defmac LINK_SPEC
206A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
207pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
208give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
209
210Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
211@end defmac
212
213@defmac LIB_SPEC
214Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
215between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
216command given to the linker.
217
218If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
219loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
220@end defmac
221
222@defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
223Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
224how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
225linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
226the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
227
228If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
229passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
230@end defmac
231
232@defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
233By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
234@code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
235instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
236depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
237@option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
238targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
239@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
240driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
241line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
242@end defmac
243
244@defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
245A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
246mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
247generated that uses --as-needed and the shared libgcc in place of the
248static exception handler library, when linking without any of
249@code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
250@end defmac
251
252@defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
253If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
254When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
255the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
256@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
257@end defmac
258
259@defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
260Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
261difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
262the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
263
264If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
265standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
266@end defmac
267
268@defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
269Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
270difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
271the very end of the command given to the linker.
272
273Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
274@end defmac
275
276@defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
277GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
278However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
279models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
280@code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
281blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
282default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
283@code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
284@end defmac
285
286@defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
287Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
288configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
289et al, within sysroot+suffix.
290@end defmac
291
292@defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
293Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
294GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
295updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
296usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
297@end defmac
298
299@defmac EXTRA_SPECS
300Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
301@file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
302@code{CC1_SPEC}.
303
304The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
305containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
306string constant that provides the specification.
307
308Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
309
310@code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
311related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
312to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
313these definitions.
314
315For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
316define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
317used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
318used.
319
320The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
321
322@smallexample
323#define EXTRA_SPECS \
324 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
325
326#define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
327@end smallexample
328
329The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
330@smallexample
331#undef CPP_SPEC
332#define CPP_SPEC \
333"%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
334%@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
335%@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
336%@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
337
338#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
339#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
340@end smallexample
341
342while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
343@code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
344
345@smallexample
346#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
347#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
348@end smallexample
349@end defmac
350
351@defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
352Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
353@file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
354the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
355@end defmac
356
357@defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
358The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
359By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
360@end defmac
361
362@defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
363A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
364linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
365change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
366define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
367line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
368the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
369@code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
370@end defmac
371
372@defmac LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
373A nonzero value causes @command{collect2} to remove duplicate @option{-L@var{directory}} search
374directories from linking commands. Do not give it a nonzero value if
375removing duplicate search directories changes the linker's semantics.
376@end defmac
377
378@defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
379Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
380string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
381target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
382@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
383
384Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
385the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
386@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
387@xref{Target Fragment}.
388@end defmac
389
390@defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
391Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
392a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
393indicates an absolute file name.
394@end defmac
395
396@defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
397If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
398@code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
399when the compiler is built as a cross
400compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
401to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
402@end defmac
403
404@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
405Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
406standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
407try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
408@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
409is built as a cross compiler.
410@end defmac
411
412@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
413Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
414standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
415when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
416@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
417is built as a cross compiler.
418@end defmac
419
420@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
421Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
422standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
423default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
424@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
425is built as a cross compiler.
426@end defmac
427
428@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
429If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
430standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
431compiler is built as a cross compiler.
432@end defmac
433
434@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
435If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
436standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
437cross compiler.
438@end defmac
439
440@defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
441Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
442variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
443loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
444initialize the necessary environment variables.
445@end defmac
446
447@defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
448Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
449standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
450try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
451comes before @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
452
453Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
454replacement.
455@end defmac
456
457@defmac SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
458Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to specify a
459system-specific directory to search for header files before the standard
460directory. @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} comes before
461@code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
462
463Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search the directory
464specified.
465@end defmac
466
467@defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
468Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
469standard choice of @file{/usr/include} as the default prefix to
470try when searching for header files.
471
472Cross compilers ignore this macro and do not search either
473@file{/usr/include} or its replacement.
474@end defmac
475
476@defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
477The ``component'' corresponding to @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}.
478See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
479If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
480@end defmac
481
482@defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
483Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
484for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
485usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
486@code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
487@code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
488and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
489and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
490@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
491
492The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
493Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
494string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
495for C++-only directories,
496and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
497wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
498the array with a null element.
499
500The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
501if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
502or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
503operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
504
505For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
506
507@smallexample
508#define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
509@{ \
510 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
511 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
512 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
513 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
514 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
515@}
516@end smallexample
517@end defmac
518
519Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
520
521@enumerate
522@item
523Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
524
525@item
526The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
527is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
528@var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
529
530@item
531The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
532
533@item
534The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
535in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
536
537@item
538The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
539
540@item
541The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
542
543@item
544The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
545compiler.
546@end enumerate
547
548Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
549
550@enumerate
551@item
552Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
553
554@item
555The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
556value based on the installed toolchain location.
557
558@item
559The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
560(or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
561
562@item
563The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
564in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
565
566@item
567The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
568
569@item
570The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
571compiler.
572
573@item
574The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
575native compiler, or we have a target system root.
576
577@item
578The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
579native compiler, or we have a target system root.
580
581@item
582The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
583If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
584the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
585
586@item
587The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
588compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
589@file{/lib/}.
590
591@item
592The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
593compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
594@file{/usr/lib/}.
595@end enumerate
596
597@node Run-time Target
598@section Run-time Target Specification
599@cindex run-time target specification
600@cindex predefined macros
601@cindex target specifications
602
603@c prevent bad page break with this line
604Here are run-time target specifications.
605
606@defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
607This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
608built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
609the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
610@code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
611calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
612finished command line option processing your code can use those
613results freely.
614
615@code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
616command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
617the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
618accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
619
620@code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
621object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
622@code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
623defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
624with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
625only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
626example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
627and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
628@code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
629defines only @code{_ABI64}.
630
631You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
632@code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
633or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
634assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
635macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
636to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
637variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
638@code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
639preprocessing.
640@end defmac
641
642@defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
643Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
644and is used for the target operating system instead.
645@end defmac
646
647@defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
648Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
649and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
650macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
651it yourself.
652@end defmac
653
654@deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
655This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
656any target-specific headers.
657@end deftypevar
658
659@hook TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
660This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
661Its default setting is 0.
662@end deftypevr
663
664@cindex optional hardware or system features
665@cindex features, optional, in system conventions
666
667@hook TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION
668This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
669target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
670(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
671processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
672definition does nothing but return true.
673
674@var{code} specifies the @code{OPT_@var{name}} enumeration value
675associated with the selected option; @var{name} is just a rendering of
676the option name in which non-alphanumeric characters are replaced by
677underscores. @var{arg} specifies the string argument and is null if
678no argument was given. If the option is flagged as a @code{UInteger}
679(@pxref{Option properties}), @var{value} is the numeric value of the
680argument. Otherwise @var{value} is 1 if the positive form of the
681option was used and 0 if the ``no-'' form was.
682@end deftypefn
683
684@hook TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION
685This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
686target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
687definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
688option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
689valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
690default definition does nothing but return false.
691
692In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
693options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
694only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
695should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
696@end deftypefn
697
91ebb981
IS
698@hook TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT
699
700@hook TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P
701
702@hook TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG
26705988 703
38f8b050
JR
704@defmac TARGET_VERSION
705This macro is a C statement to print on @code{stderr} a string
706describing the particular machine description choice. Every machine
707description should define @code{TARGET_VERSION}. For example:
708
709@smallexample
710#ifdef MOTOROLA
711#define TARGET_VERSION \
712 fprintf (stderr, " (68k, Motorola syntax)");
713#else
714#define TARGET_VERSION \
715 fprintf (stderr, " (68k, MIT syntax)");
716#endif
717@end smallexample
718@end defmac
719
38f8b050
JR
720@hook TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE
721This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
722but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
723pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
724attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
725when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
726actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
727@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
728@end deftypefn
729
730@defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
c5387660
JM
731This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
732but is only used in the C
38f8b050
JR
733language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
734used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
735frontends.
736@end defmac
737
3020190e 738@hook TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
38f8b050 739Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
3020190e
JM
740various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
741options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
742options are processed once
38f8b050 743just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
3020190e
JM
744of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
745options passed explicily.
38f8b050 746
3020190e 747This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
38f8b050
JR
748options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
749@code{optimize} attribute.
3020190e 750@end deftypevr
38f8b050 751
7e4aae92
JM
752@hook TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT
753
128dc8e2
JM
754@hook TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS
755
38f8b050
JR
756@hook TARGET_HELP
757This hook is called in response to the user invoking
758@option{--target-help} on the command line. It gives the target a
759chance to display extra information on the target specific command
760line options found in its @file{.opt} file.
761@end deftypefn
762
3bd36029
RS
763@defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
764Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
765during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
766the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
767can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
768and @code{nomips16} attributes.
769
770Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
771registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
772operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
773in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
774significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
775for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
776switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
777
778Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
779is 0.
780@end defmac
781
38f8b050
JR
782@node Per-Function Data
783@section Defining data structures for per-function information.
784@cindex per-function data
785@cindex data structures
786
787If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
788provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
789using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
790nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
791when another one comes along.
792
793GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
794contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
795structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
796@code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
797to their own specific data.
798
799If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
800@code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
801This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
802@code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
803
804One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
805RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
806RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
807function, for level 0.
808
809Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
810all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
811function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
812stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
813stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
814@code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
815the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
816single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
817longer supported.
818
819@defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
820Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
821is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
822The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
823function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
824@end defmac
825
826@deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
827If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
828function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
829target to perform any target specific initialization of the
830@code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
831used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
832
833@code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
834Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
835GC allocation, including the structure itself.
836@end deftypevar
837
838@node Storage Layout
839@section Storage Layout
840@cindex storage layout
841
842Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
843alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
844expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
845@xref{Run-time Target}.
846
847@defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
848Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
849byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
850This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
851bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
852be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
853macro need not be a constant.
854
855This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
856bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
857@end defmac
858
859@defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
860Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
861word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
862@end defmac
863
864@defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
865Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
866most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
867memory locations and registers; GCC fundamentally assumes that the
868order of words in memory is the same as the order in registers. This
869macro need not be a constant.
870@end defmac
871
38f8b050
JR
872@defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
873Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
874@code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
875containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
876have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
877
878You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
879multi-word integers.
880@end defmac
881
882@defmac BITS_PER_UNIT
883Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
884unit (byte). If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
885@end defmac
886
887@defmac BITS_PER_WORD
888Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
889is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
890@end defmac
891
892@defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
893Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
894@code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
895largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
896@end defmac
897
898@defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
899Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
900register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
901@end defmac
902
903@defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
904Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
905@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
906smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
907@end defmac
908
38f8b050
JR
909@defmac POINTER_SIZE
910Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
911width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
912you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
913a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
914@end defmac
915
916@defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
917A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
918@code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
919greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
920should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
921is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
922@code{ptr_extend} instruction.
923
924You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
925and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
926@end defmac
927
928@defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
929A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
930is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
931stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
932scalar type.
933
934On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
935register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
936@var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
937cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
938floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
939counterparts.
940
941For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
942However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
943either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
944the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
945sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
946@var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
947
948Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
949@end defmac
950
951@hook TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE
952Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
953function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
954and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
955change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
956pointer} types.
957
958@var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
959return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
960@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
961If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
962which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
963then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
964the signedness may be different.
965
966The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
967also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
968if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
969@end deftypefn
970
971@defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
972Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
973bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
974regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
975size of an integer.
976@end defmac
977
978@defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
979Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
980stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
981desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
982if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
983this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
984@end defmac
985
986@defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
987Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
988stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
989is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
990macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
991@code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
992@end defmac
993
994@defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
995Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
996from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
997to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
998@end defmac
999
1000@defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1001Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1002@end defmac
1003
1004@defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1005Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1006bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1007just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
1008@end defmac
1009
1010@defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1011Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1012provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1013@end defmac
1014
1015@defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1016Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1017not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1018@end defmac
1019
1020@defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1021If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1022object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1023nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1024on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1025@end defmac
1026
1027@defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1028Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1029machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1030structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1031by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1032@end defmac
1033
1034@defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1035An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1036alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1037@code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1038alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1039field alignment has not been set by the
1040@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1041@end defmac
1042
1043@defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1044Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1045to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1046
1047If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1048
1049@c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1050@c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1051@c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1052@c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1053@end defmac
1054
1055@defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1056Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1057Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1058@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1059the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1060
1061On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1062the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1063a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((unsigned HOST_WIDEST_INT) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1064On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1065@samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1066@end defmac
1067
1068@defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1069If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1070the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1071the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1072macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1073
1074If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1075
1076@findex strcpy
1077One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1078make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1079arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1080constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1081@end defmac
1082
1083@defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1084If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1085that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1086@var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1087have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1088align the object.
1089
1090If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1091
1092The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1093constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1094constants can be done inline.
1095@end defmac
1096
1097@defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1098If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1099the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1100the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1101macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1102
1103If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1104
1105One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1106make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
4a6336ad
JR
1107
1108It the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
38f8b050
JR
1109@end defmac
1110
1111@defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1112If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1113@var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1114and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1115have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1116align the slot.
1117
1118If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1119@var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1120be used.
1121
1122This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1123of all possible modes which the slot may have.
4a6336ad
JR
1124
1125It the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
38f8b050
JR
1126@end defmac
1127
1128@defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1129If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1130variable @var{decl}.
1131
1132If this macro is not defined, then
1133@code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1134is used.
1135
1136One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1137make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
4a6336ad
JR
1138
1139It the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
38f8b050
JR
1140@end defmac
1141
1142@defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1143If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1144for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1145@var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1146
1147If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1148@end defmac
1149
1150@defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1151Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1152empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1153
1154If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1155@end defmac
1156
1157@defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1158Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1159Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1160
1161If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1162@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1163@end defmac
1164
1165@defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1166Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1167if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1168go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1169@end defmac
1170
1171@defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1172Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1173alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1174
1175The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1176@code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1177structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1178that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1179that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1180
1181Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1182@code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1183four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1184not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1185
1186An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1187structure.
1188
1189If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1190a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1191
1192Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1193bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1194support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1195@samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1196
1197The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1198@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1199Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1200
1201Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1202@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1203@code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1204
1205If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1206bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1207what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1208
1209@smallexample
1210struct foo1
1211@{
1212 char x;
1213 char :0;
1214 char y;
1215@};
1216
1217struct foo2
1218@{
1219 char x;
1220 int :0;
1221 char y;
1222@};
1223
1224main ()
1225@{
1226 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1227 sizeof (struct foo1));
1228 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1229 sizeof (struct foo2));
1230 exit (0);
1231@}
1232@end smallexample
1233
1234If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1235get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1236@end defmac
1237
1238@defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1239Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1240to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1241@end defmac
1242
1243@hook TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD
1244When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1245whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1246structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1247the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1248@end deftypefn
1249
1250@hook TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD
1251This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1252should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1253these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1254
1255The default is @code{!TARGET_STRICT_ALIGN}.
1256@end deftypefn
1257
1258@defmac MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (@var{field}, @var{mode})
1259Return 1 if a structure or array containing @var{field} should be accessed using
1260@code{BLKMODE}.
1261
1262If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1263mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1264case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1265retain the field's mode.
1266
1267Normally, this is not needed.
1268@end defmac
1269
1270@defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1271Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1272by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1273way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1274@var{specified}.
1275
1276The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1277the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1278@end defmac
1279
1280@defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1281An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1282machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1283this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1284appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1285(DImode)} is assumed.
1286@end defmac
1287
1288@defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1289If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1290specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1291@code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1292@var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1293@code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1294having its mode specified.
1295
1296You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1297would most commonly define this macro if the
1298@code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
129964-bit mode.
1300@end defmac
1301
1302@defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1303If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1304specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1305@code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1306
1307You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1308You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1309pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1310@end defmac
1311
1312@hook TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE
1313This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1314of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1315@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1316targets.
1317@end deftypefn
1318
1319@hook TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE
1320This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1321of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1322@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1323targets.
1324@end deftypefn
1325
1326@hook TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE
1327Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1328The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1329@end deftypefn
1330
1331@defmac ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1332If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
1333mode is towards zero.
1334
1335Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1336floating-point arithmetic.
1337
1338Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
1339@end defmac
1340
1341@defmac LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
1342This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
1343bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1344exponent for normal numbers instead.
1345
1346Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1347floating-point arithmetic.
1348
1349The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
1350@end defmac
1351
1352@hook TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P
1353This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1354@var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1355Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1356unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1357different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1358alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1359bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1360the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1361(iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1362another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1363other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1364
1365When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1366of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1367bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1368and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1369chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1370size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1371alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1372
1373If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1374the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1375used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1376precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1377may affect its placement.
1378@end deftypefn
1379
1380@hook TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P
1381Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1382@end deftypefn
1383
1384@hook TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P
1385Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1386@end deftypefn
1387
1388@hook TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK
1389This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1390to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1391For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1392for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1393registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1394usage.
1395@end deftypefn
1396
1397@hook TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS
1398This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1399that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1400@end deftypefn
1401
1402@hook TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE
1403If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1404uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1405to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1406mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1407the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1408not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1409for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1410return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1411string constant.
1412
1413Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1414qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1415fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1416is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1417length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1418ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1419@var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1420@var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1421code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1422@code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1423codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1424spaces in your string.
1425
1426This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1427name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1428can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1429before mangling.
1430
1431The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1432appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1433types.
1434@end deftypefn
1435
1436@node Type Layout
1437@section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1438
1439These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1440basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1441the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1442languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1443
1444@defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1445A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1446target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1447@end defmac
1448
1449@defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1450A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1451target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1452(If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1453unit.)
1454@end defmac
1455
1456@defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1457A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1458target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1459@end defmac
1460
1461@defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1462On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1463@code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1464that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1465the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1466value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1467@end defmac
1468
1469@defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1470A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1471target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1472words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1473macro must be at least 64.
1474@end defmac
1475
1476@defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1477A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1478target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1479@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1480@end defmac
1481
1482@defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1483A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1484C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1485this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1486@end defmac
1487
1488@defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1489A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1490target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1491@end defmac
1492
1493@defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1494A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1495target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1496words.
1497@end defmac
1498
1499@defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1500A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1501the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1502words.
1503@end defmac
1504
1505@defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1506A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1507the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1508@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1509@end defmac
1510
1511@defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1512A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1513the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1514@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1515@end defmac
1516
1517@defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1518A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1519the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1520@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1521@end defmac
1522
1523@defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1524A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1525the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1526@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1527@end defmac
1528
1529@defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1530A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1531the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1532@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1533@end defmac
1534
1535@defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1536A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1537the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1538@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1539@end defmac
1540
1541@defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1542A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1543the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1544@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1545@end defmac
1546
1547@defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1548A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1549the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1550@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1551@end defmac
1552
1553@defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1554Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
1555if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
1556@code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. If you don't define this, the
1557default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1558@end defmac
1559
1560@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_DF_MODE
a18bdccd 1561Define this macro if neither @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} nor
38f8b050
JR
1562@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is
1563@code{DFmode} but you want @code{DFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
a18bdccd 1564anyway. If you don't define this and either @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
38f8b050
JR
1565or @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64 then the default is 1,
1566otherwise it is 0.
1567@end defmac
1568
1569@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_XF_MODE
1570Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1571@code{XFmode} but you want @code{XFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1572anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1573is 80 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1574@end defmac
1575
1576@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_TF_MODE
1577Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1578@code{TFmode} but you want @code{TFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1579anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1580is 128 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1581@end defmac
1582
1583@defmac SF_SIZE
1584@defmacx DF_SIZE
1585@defmacx XF_SIZE
1586@defmacx TF_SIZE
1587Define these macros to be the size in bits of the mantissa of
1588@code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} values,
1589if the defaults in @file{libgcc2.h} are inappropriate. By default,
1590@code{FLT_MANT_DIG} is used for @code{SF_SIZE}, @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG}
1591for @code{XF_SIZE} and @code{TF_SIZE}, and @code{DBL_MANT_DIG} or
1592@code{LDBL_MANT_DIG} for @code{DF_SIZE} according to whether
a18bdccd 1593@code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} or
38f8b050
JR
1594@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64.
1595@end defmac
1596
1597@defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1598A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1599assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1600default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1601@code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1602@end defmac
1603
1604@defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1605A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1606supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1607value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1608If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1609is the default.
1610@end defmac
1611
1612@defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1613An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1614@code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1615always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1616and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1617@end defmac
1618
1619@hook TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1620This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1621@code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1622of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1623@code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1624
1625The default is to return false.
1626@end deftypefn
1627
1628@defmac SIZE_TYPE
1629A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1630for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1631contents of the string.
1632
1633The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1634spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1635appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1636of the data type names defined in the function
1637@code{init_decl_processing} in the file @file{c-decl.c}. You may not
1638omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the compiler to
1639crash on startup.
1640
1641If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1642int"}.
1643@end defmac
1644
1645@defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1646A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1647for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1648@code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1649@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1650
1651If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1652@end defmac
1653
1654@defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1655A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1656for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1657the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1658information.
1659
1660If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1661@end defmac
1662
1663@defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1664A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1665characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1666@code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1667@end defmac
1668
1669@defmac WINT_TYPE
1670A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1671use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1672@code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1673contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1674information.
1675
1676If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1677@end defmac
1678
1679@defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1680A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1681can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1682The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1683string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1684
1685If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1686@code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1687much precision as @code{long long int}.
1688@end defmac
1689
1690@defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1691A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1692can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1693type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1694of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1695
1696If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1697@code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1698unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1699int}.
1700@end defmac
1701
1702@defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1703@defmacx INT8_TYPE
1704@defmacx INT16_TYPE
1705@defmacx INT32_TYPE
1706@defmacx INT64_TYPE
1707@defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1708@defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1709@defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1710@defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1711@defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1712@defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1713@defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1714@defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1715@defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1716@defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1717@defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1718@defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1719@defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1720@defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1721@defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1722@defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1723@defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1724@defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1725@defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1726@defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1727@defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1728@defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1729C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1730@code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1731@code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1732@code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1733@code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1734@code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1735@code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1736@code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1737@code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1738@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1739
1740If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1741type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1742@code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1743to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1744these macros are null pointers.
1745@end defmac
1746
1747@defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1748The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1749that looks like:
1750
1751@smallexample
1752 struct @{
1753 union @{
1754 void (*fn)();
1755 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1756 @};
1757 ptrdiff_t delta;
1758 @};
1759@end smallexample
1760
1761@noindent
1762The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1763will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1764Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1765always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1766distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1767platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1768that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1769the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1770
1771GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1772this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1773However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1774set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1775bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1776address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1777architecture, you should define this macro to
1778@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1779
1780In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1781in which function addresses are always even, according to
1782@code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1783@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1784@end defmac
1785
1786@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1787Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1788macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1789instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1790function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1791data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1792pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1793
1794If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1795of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1796@end defmac
1797
1798@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1799By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1800is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1801the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1802when special alignment is necessary. */
1803@end defmac
1804
1805@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1806There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1807zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1808specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1809of words in each data entry.
1810@end defmac
1811
1812@node Registers
1813@section Register Usage
1814@cindex register usage
1815
1816This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1817has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1818
1819The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1820done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1821on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1822For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1823For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1824
1825@menu
1826* Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1827* Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1828* Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1829* Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1830* Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1831@end menu
1832
1833@node Register Basics
1834@subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1835
1836@c prevent bad page break with this line
1837Registers have various characteristics.
1838
1839@defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1840Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1841numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1842pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1843@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1844@end defmac
1845
1846@defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1847@cindex fixed register
1848An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1849all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1850general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1851pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1852register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1853machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1854and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1855
1856This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1857commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1858register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1859
1860The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1861the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1862by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1863the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1864@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1865@end defmac
1866
1867@defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1868@cindex call-used register
1869@cindex call-clobbered register
1870@cindex call-saved register
1871Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1872clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1873registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1874available for general allocation of values that must live across
1875function calls.
1876
1877If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1878automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1879exit, if the register is used within the function.
1880@end defmac
1881
1882@defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1883@cindex call-used register
1884@cindex call-clobbered register
1885@cindex call-saved register
1886Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1887that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1888(@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1889This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1890of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1891@end defmac
1892
1893@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1894@cindex call-used register
1895@cindex call-clobbered register
1896@cindex call-saved register
1897A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1898value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1899call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1900macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1901preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1902@end defmac
1903
1904@findex fixed_regs
1905@findex call_used_regs
1906@findex global_regs
1907@findex reg_names
1908@findex reg_class_contents
5efd84c5
NF
1909@hook TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1910This hook may conditionally modify five variables
38f8b050
JR
1911@code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1912@code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1913any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1914of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1915@code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1916@code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1917called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1918@code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1919from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1920@code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1921@code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1922@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1923command options have been applied.
1924
38f8b050
JR
1925@cindex disabling certain registers
1926@cindex controlling register usage
1927If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1928flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1929@code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1930registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also define
1931the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
1932to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
1933is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1934
1935(However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1936of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1937controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1938these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
5efd84c5 1939@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
1940
1941@defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1942Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1943expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1944corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1945function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1946outbound register.
1947@end defmac
1948
1949@defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1950Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1951expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1952corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1953function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1954register.
1955@end defmac
1956
1957@defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1958Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1959expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1960register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1961need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1962gotos.
1963@end defmac
1964
1965@defmac PC_REGNUM
1966If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1967register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
1968@end defmac
1969
1970@node Allocation Order
1971@subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1972@cindex order of register allocation
1973@cindex register allocation order
1974
1975@c prevent bad page break with this line
1976Registers are allocated in order.
1977
1978@defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1979If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
1980numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
1981to use them (from most preferred to least).
1982
1983If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1984(all else being equal).
1985
1986One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1987registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1988instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
1989machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
1990the highest numbered allocable register first.
1991@end defmac
1992
1993@defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1994A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
1995hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
1996
1997Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
1998Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
1999register; and so on.
2000
2001The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
2002@code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
2003
2004On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2005@end defmac
2006
2007@defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2008Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
2009prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
2010using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
2011allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
2012call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, this macro
2013should be defined.
2014@end defmac
2015
2016@defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2017In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2018Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2019If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2020based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2021be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2022value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2023to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2024
2025On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2026@end defmac
2027
2028@node Values in Registers
2029@subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2030
2031This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2032(specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2033consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2034
2035@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2036A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2037at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2038@var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2039cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2040and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2041
2042On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2043definition of this macro is
2044
2045@smallexample
2046#define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2047 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2048 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2049@end smallexample
2050@end defmac
2051
2052@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2053A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2054in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2055in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2056multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2057this mode by the number of registers returned by
2058@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2059
2060For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2061registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2062nonzero.
2063
2064This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2065@code{subreg_get_info}
2066would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2067represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2068@code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2069registers and so not be representable.
2070@end defmac
2071
2072@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2073For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2074@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2075returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2076including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2077@end defmac
2078
2079@defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2080Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2081of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2082should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2083used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2084happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2085floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2086@end defmac
2087
2088@defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2089A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2090of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2091registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2092are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2093
2094@smallexample
2095#define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2096@end smallexample
2097
2098You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2099because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2100
2101@cindex register pairs
2102On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2103register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2104odd register numbers for such modes.
2105
2106The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2107@samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2108register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2109value into the register and back out not alter it.
2110
2111Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2112all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2113@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2114you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2115is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2116and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2117to be tieable.
2118
2119Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2120Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2121in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2122can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2123mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2124registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2125
2126On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2127modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2128registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2129non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2130@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2131floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2132normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2133unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2134register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2135
2136The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2137they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2138instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2139@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2140constraints for those instructions.
2141
2142On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2143so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2144register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2145floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2146be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2147@end defmac
2148
2149@defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2150A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2151@var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2152
2153One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2154another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2155handler.
2156
2157The default is always nonzero.
2158@end defmac
2159
2160@defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2161A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2162@var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2163
2164If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2165@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2166any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2167should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2168this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2169accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2170
2171You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2172possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2173allocation.
2174@end defmac
2175
2176@hook TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK
2177This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2178@var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2179
2180One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2181is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2182
2183The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2184@end deftypefn
2185
2186@defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2187Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2188registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2189@code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2190@end defmac
2191
2192@node Leaf Functions
2193@subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2194
2195@cindex leaf functions
2196@cindex functions, leaf
2197On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2198more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2199means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2200are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2201normally arrive.
2202
2203The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2204other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2205registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2206function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2207handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2208functions''.
2209
2210GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2211suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2212registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2213accomplish this.
2214
2215@defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2216Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2217contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2218function treatment.
2219
2220If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2221registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2222GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2223used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2224in this vector.
2225
2226Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2227the treatment of leaf functions.
2228@end defmac
2229
2230@defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2231A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2232should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2233
2234If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2235function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2236will cause the compiler to abort.
2237
2238Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2239treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2240this.
2241@end defmac
2242
2243@findex current_function_is_leaf
2244@findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2245@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2246@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2247specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2248which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2249set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2250compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2251@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2252functions which only use leaf registers.
2253@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2254that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2255@code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2256@c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2257@c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2258
2259@node Stack Registers
2260@subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2261
2262There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2263``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2264pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2265stack.
2266
2267Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2268they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2269support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2270point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2271stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2272@file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2273with it, as well as defining these macros.
2274
2275@defmac STACK_REGS
2276Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2277@end defmac
2278
2279@defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2280This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2281the machine has any stack-like registers.
2282@end defmac
2283
2284@defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2285The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2286of the stack.
2287@end defmac
2288
2289@defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2290The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2291the stack.
2292@end defmac
2293
2294@node Register Classes
2295@section Register Classes
2296@cindex register class definitions
2297@cindex class definitions, register
2298
2299On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2300For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2301certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2302restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2303
2304You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2305which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2306that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2307
2308@findex ALL_REGS
2309@findex NO_REGS
2310In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2311class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2312class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2313union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2314
2315@findex GENERAL_REGS
2316One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2317terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2318@samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2319the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2320to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2321
2322Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2323then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2324
2325The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2326constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2327You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2328them in operand constraints.
2329
2330You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2331instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2332either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2333certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2334which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code.
2335
2336You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2337classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2338contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2339in their union.
2340
2341When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2342certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2343Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2344a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2345specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2346
2347Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2348instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2349each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2350mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2351single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2352this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2353instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2354single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2355@code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2356
2357@deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2358An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2359as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2360must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2361@code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2362tells how many classes there are.
2363
2364Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2365the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2366in many of the tables described below.
2367@end deftp
2368
2369@defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2370The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2371
2372@smallexample
2373#define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2374@end smallexample
2375@end defmac
2376
2377@defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2378An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2379constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2380@end defmac
2381
2382@defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2383An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2384which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2385@var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2386register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2387
2388When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2389Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2390several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2391for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2392In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2393registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2394so on.
2395@end defmac
2396
2397@defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2398A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2399@var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2400which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2401register.
2402@end defmac
2403
2404@defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2405A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2406base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2407which is the register value plus a displacement.
2408@end defmac
2409
2410@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2411This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2412the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2413@var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2414@code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2415@end defmac
2416
2417@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2418A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2419base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2420register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2421addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2422@end defmac
2423
2424@defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2425A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2426base register must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code} define the
2427context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is the code of
2428the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level of an
2429address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2430@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2431index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2432@end defmac
2433
2434@defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2435A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2436index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2437address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2438added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2439@end defmac
2440
2441@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2442A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2443suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
38f8b050
JR
2444@end defmac
2445
2446@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2447A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2448that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2449@var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2450reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2451you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2452@code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2453addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2454@code{address_operand}.
38f8b050
JR
2455@end defmac
2456
2457@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2458A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2459use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2460memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2461pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2462define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2463than other base register uses.
2464
2465Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2466@code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
38f8b050
JR
2467@end defmac
2468
2469@defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2470A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2471that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2472appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2473immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2474address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2475@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2476corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2477@code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2478that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
38f8b050
JR
2479@end defmac
2480
2481@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2482A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2483suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2484either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2485allocated such a hard register.
2486
2487The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2488the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2489two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2490labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2491labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2492may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2493looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2494only if neither labeling works.
38f8b050
JR
2495@end defmac
2496
fba42e24
AS
2497@hook TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS
2498A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2499to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2500@var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2501another, smaller class.
2502
2503The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2504
2505Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2506example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2507for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2508@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2509Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2510
2511One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2512@var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2513loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2514force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2515immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2516instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2517register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2518@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2519into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2520@code{LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2521of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2522
2523If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2524through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2525to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2526reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2527this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2528the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2529@end deftypefn
2530
38f8b050
JR
2531@defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2532A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2533to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2534@var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2535another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2536safe:
2537
2538@smallexample
2539#define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2540@end smallexample
2541
2542Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2543example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2544for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2545@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2546Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2547
2548One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2549@var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2550loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2551force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2552immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2553instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2554register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2555@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2556into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2557@code{LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2558of using @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2559
2560If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2561through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2562to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2563reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2564this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2565the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2566@end defmac
2567
2568@defmac PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2569Like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2570input reloads. If you don't define this macro, the default is to use
2571@var{class}, unchanged.
2572
2573You can also use @code{PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2574reload from using some alternatives, like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2575@end defmac
2576
abd26bfb
AS
2577@hook TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2578Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2579input reloads.
2580
2581The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2582argument.
2583
2584You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2585reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2586@end deftypefn
2587
38f8b050
JR
2588@defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2589A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2590to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2591@var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2592ordinarily be used.
2593
2594Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2595there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2596
2597The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2598smaller class.
2599
2600Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2601require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2602@end defmac
2603
2604@hook TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD
2605Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2606from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2607@samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2608from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2609term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2610directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2611register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2612destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2613source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2614reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2615and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2616intermediate register still holds the required value.
2617
2618Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2619allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2620register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2621address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2622when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2623as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2624that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2625describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2626these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2627of the scratch register(s).
2628
2629In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2630
2631For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2632and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2633@var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2634hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2635needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2636
2637If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2638an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2639return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2640If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2641If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2642that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2643
2644If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2645perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2646closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2647required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2648copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2649
2650You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2651in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2652and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2653for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2654single-register-class
2655@c [later: or memory]
2656output constraint.
2657
2658When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2659hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2660register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2661have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2662
2663@c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2664@c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2665@c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2666@c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2667@c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2668@c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2669@c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2670@c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2671
2672
2673@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2674pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2675Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2676in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2677
2678Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2679currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2680to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2681
2682@code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2683copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2684(a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2685Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2686of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2687forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2688@end deftypefn
2689
2690@defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2691@defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2692@defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2693These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2694@code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2695
2696These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2697target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2698reload phase that it may
2699need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2700register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2701register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2702you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2703largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2704intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2705
2706If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2707intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2708was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2709class required. If the
2710requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2711@code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2712macros identically.
2713
2714The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2715Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2716can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2717@var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2718macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2719
2720If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2721intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2722@samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2723(@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2724implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2725@samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2726register.
2727
2728These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2729register that
2730contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2731class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2732value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2733register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2734Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2735
2736@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2737pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2738Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2739in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2740
2741These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2742registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2743registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2744would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2745the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2746intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2747general registers.
2748@end defmac
2749
2750@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2751Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2752to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2753those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2754@var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2755class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2756and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2757
2758Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2759@end defmac
2760
2761@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2762Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2763allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2764If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2765defined by this macro.
2766
2767Do not define this macro if you do not define
2768@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2769@end defmac
2770
2771@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2772When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2773registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2774hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2775load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2776same as that of @var{mode}.
2777
2778This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2779bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2780in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2781registers.
2782
2783However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2784the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2785differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2786widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2787suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2788details.
2789
2790Do not define this macro if you do not define
2791@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2792is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2793@end defmac
2794
07b8f0a8
AS
2795@hook TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P
2796A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2797to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2798registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2799
2800The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2801has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2802default should be used. Only use this target hook to some other expression
2803if pseudos allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their
2804hard registers were needed for spill registers. If this target hook returns
2805@code{false} for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2806@file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2807register. If there would not be another register available for reallocation,
2808you should not change the implementation of this target hook since
2809the only effect of such implementation would be to slow down register
2810allocation.
2811@end deftypefn
2812
38f8b050
JR
2813@defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2814A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2815of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2816
2817This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2818the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2819should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2820@var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2821
2822This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2823in the reload pass.
2824@end defmac
2825
2826@defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2827If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2828a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2829
2830For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2831floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2832Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2833does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2834register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2835as below:
2836
2837@smallexample
2838#define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2839 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2840 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2841@end smallexample
2842@end defmac
2843
2844@hook TARGET_IRA_COVER_CLASSES
2845Return an array of cover classes for the Integrated Register Allocator
2846(@acronym{IRA}). Cover classes are a set of non-intersecting register
2847classes covering all hard registers used for register allocation
2848purposes. If a move between two registers in the same cover class is
2849possible, it should be cheaper than a load or store of the registers.
2850The array is terminated by a @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES} element.
2851
2852The order of cover classes in the array is important. If two classes
2853have the same cost of usage for a pseudo, the class occurred first in
2854the array is chosen for the pseudo.
2855
2856This hook is called once at compiler startup, after the command-line
2857options have been processed. It is then re-examined by every call to
2858@code{target_reinit}.
2859
2860The default implementation returns @code{IRA_COVER_CLASSES}, if defined,
2861otherwise there is no default implementation. You must define either this
2862macro or @code{IRA_COVER_CLASSES} in order to use the integrated register
2863allocator with Chaitin-Briggs coloring. If the macro is not defined,
2864the only available coloring algorithm is Chow's priority coloring.
2865@end deftypefn
2866
2867@defmac IRA_COVER_CLASSES
2868See the documentation for @code{TARGET_IRA_COVER_CLASSES}.
2869@end defmac
2870
2871@node Old Constraints
2872@section Obsolete Macros for Defining Constraints
2873@cindex defining constraints, obsolete method
2874@cindex constraints, defining, obsolete method
2875
2876Machine-specific constraints can be defined with these macros instead
2877of the machine description constructs described in @ref{Define
2878Constraints}. This mechanism is obsolete. New ports should not use
2879it; old ports should convert to the new mechanism.
2880
2881@defmac CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2882For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2883@var{c}, return the length. This allows you to have register class /
2884constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2885you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2886constraints only. The definition of this macro should use
2887DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2888to handle specially.
2889There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2890for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2891transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2892return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2893will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2894@end defmac
2895
2896@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2897A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2898letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2899value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
2900the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
2901corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2902to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2903@end defmac
2904
2905@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2906Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2907passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2908different variants.
2909@end defmac
2910
2911@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2912A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2913letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2914particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
2915letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2916the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
2917not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2918@var{value}.
2919@end defmac
2920
2921@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2922Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2923string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2924between different variants.
2925@end defmac
2926
2927@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2928A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2929letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2930(@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2931
2932If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2933@var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2934range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
2935letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2936
2937@code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2938@code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
2939or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2940between these kinds.
2941@end defmac
2942
2943@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2944Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2945string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2946between different variants.
2947@end defmac
2948
2949@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
2950A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2951letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2952memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
2953elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
2954@code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
2955may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
2956
2957If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
2958if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
2959constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
2960constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2961
2962For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
2963in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
2964letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
2965@emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
2966a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
2967alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
2968does not include r0 on the output.
2969@end defmac
2970
2971@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2972Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
2973in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
2974variants.
2975@end defmac
2976
2977@defmac EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2978A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2979letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
2980be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
2981
2982It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2983at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
2984comprises a subset of all memory references including
2985all those whose address is simply a base register. This allows the reload
2986pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
2987type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
2988
2989For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
2990memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
2991register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
2992@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
2993If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
2994a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
2995reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
2996into a base register if required. This is analogous to the way
2997an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
2998@end defmac
2999
3000@defmac EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
3001A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3002letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
3003@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
3004be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
3005
3006It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3007at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
3008a subset of all memory addresses including
3009all those that consist of just a base register. This allows the reload
3010pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3011type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
3012
3013Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
3014be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate. It is treated
3015analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
3016@end defmac
3017
3018@node Stack and Calling
3019@section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
3020@cindex calling conventions
3021
3022@c prevent bad page break with this line
3023This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
3024
3025@menu
3026* Frame Layout::
3027* Exception Handling::
3028* Stack Checking::
3029* Frame Registers::
3030* Elimination::
3031* Stack Arguments::
3032* Register Arguments::
3033* Scalar Return::
3034* Aggregate Return::
3035* Caller Saves::
3036* Function Entry::
3037* Profiling::
3038* Tail Calls::
3039* Stack Smashing Protection::
3040@end menu
3041
3042@node Frame Layout
3043@subsection Basic Stack Layout
3044@cindex stack frame layout
3045@cindex frame layout
3046
3047@c prevent bad page break with this line
3048Here is the basic stack layout.
3049
3050@defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3051Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
3052pointer to a smaller address.
3053
3054When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
3055compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
3056definition used does not matter.
3057@end defmac
3058
3059@defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
3060This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
3061on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
3062@code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
3063
3064The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
3065and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
3066the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
3067to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
3068space for the next item on the stack.
3069
3070The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
3071defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
3072which is often wrong.
3073@end defmac
3074
3075@defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3076Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
3077are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
3078@end defmac
3079
3080@defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
3081Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
3082addresses on the stack.
3083@end defmac
3084
3085@defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
3086Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
3087
3088If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
3089subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3090Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
3091value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3092@c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
3093@c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
3094@end defmac
3095
3096@defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
3097Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
3098The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3099
3100On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
3101is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3102alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3103stack alignment and do it in the backend.
3104@end defmac
3105
3106@defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
3107Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3108outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3109zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3110
3111If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3112the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3113@end defmac
3114
3115@defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3116Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3117address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3118function.
3119
3120If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3121the first argument's address.
3122@end defmac
3123
3124@defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3125Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3126on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3127
3128The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3129length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3130machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3131@end defmac
3132
3133@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3134A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3135stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3136@code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3137default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3138elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3139@code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3140@end defmac
3141
3142@defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3143A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3144frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3145@var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3146itself.
3147
3148If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3149of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3150address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3151@end defmac
3152
3153@defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3154If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3155setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3156on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3157before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3158define this macro.
3159@end defmac
3160
3161@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
3162This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3163the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3164The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3165machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3166@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3167@end deftypefn
3168
3169@defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3170A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3171address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3172of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3173You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3174as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3175@end defmac
3176
3177@defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3178A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3179address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3180the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3181frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3182@code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
3183
3184The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3185@var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3186determine the return address of other frames.
3187@end defmac
3188
3189@defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3190Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
3191from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
3192@end defmac
3193
3194@defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3195A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3196incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3197prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3198value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3199the stack.
3200
3201You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3202debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3203
3204If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3205@code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3206@end defmac
3207
3208@defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3209A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3210number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3211must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3212be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3213
3214This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3215general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3216frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3217over time.
3218@end defmac
3219
3220@defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3221A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3222number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3223only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3224someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3225terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3226@end defmac
3227
3228@hook TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC
3229This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3230contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3231info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3232@smallexample
3233(set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3234@end smallexample
3235and
3236@smallexample
3237(set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3238@end smallexample
3239to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3240the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3241the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3242@end deftypefn
3243
3244@defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3245A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3246from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3247frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3248the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3249previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3250
3251You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3252debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3253@end defmac
3254
3255@defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3256A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3257from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3258final value should coincide with that calculated by
3259@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3260during virtual register instantiation.
3261
3262The default value for this macro is
3263@code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3264which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3265immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3266some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3267and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3268
3269You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3270want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3271DWARF 2.
3272@end defmac
3273
3274@defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3275If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3276in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3277The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3278@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3279
3280Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3281via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3282variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3283defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3284based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3285of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3286should be defined.
3287@end defmac
3288
3289@defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3290If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3291in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3292in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3293may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3294@end defmac
3295
3296@node Exception Handling
3297@subsection Exception Handling Support
3298@cindex exception handling
3299
3300@defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3301A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3302data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3303@var{N} registers are usable.
3304
3305The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3306handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3307should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3308but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
33092 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3310
3311You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3312handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3313@end defmac
3314
3315@defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3316A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3317to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3318This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3319It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3320
3321Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3322untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3323
3324Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3325by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3326this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3327stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3328this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3329that provided by DWARF 2.
3330@end defmac
3331
3332@defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3333A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3334to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3335return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3336
3337Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3338return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3339address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3340the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3341frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3342been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3343target call frame.
3344
3345Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3346address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3347the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3348
3349If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3350define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3351@end defmac
3352
3353@defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3354If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3355to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3356exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3357using it to return to the exception handler.
3358@end defmac
3359
3360@defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3361This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3362handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3363that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3364and so may be read-only.
3365
3366@var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3367@var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3368The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3369as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3370
3371If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3372represented directly.
3373@end defmac
3374
3375@defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3376This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3377to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3378Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3379be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3380
3381This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3382handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3383of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3384to be emitted.
3385@end defmac
3386
3387@defmac MD_UNWIND_SUPPORT
3388A string specifying a file to be #include'd in unwind-dw2.c. The file
3389so included typically defines @code{MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR}.
3390@end defmac
3391
3392@defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3393This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3394code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3395available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3396through signal frames.
3397
3398This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3399@file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3400@file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3401@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3402for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3403the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3404save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3405evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3406the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3407
3408For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3409@code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3410@end defmac
3411
3412@defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3413This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3414call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3415usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3416
3417This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in @file{unwind-ia64.c}.
3418@var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3419@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3420for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3421@code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3422be updated in @var{fs}.
3423@end defmac
3424
3425@defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3426A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3427info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3428linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3429@end defmac
3430
3431@node Stack Checking
3432@subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3433
3434GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3435stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3436three ways:
3437
3438@enumerate
3439@item
3440If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3441will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3442at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3443other special processing.
3444
3445@item
3446If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3447@code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3448that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3449static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3450in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3451stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3452approach below.
3453
3454@item
3455If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3456``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3457@end enumerate
3458
3459If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3460GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3461@option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3462dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3463
3464@defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3465A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3466machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3467is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3468checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3469value of this macro is zero.
3470@end defmac
3471
3472@defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3473A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3474in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3475like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3476approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3477@end defmac
3478
3479@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3480An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3481instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3482define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3483the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3484of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3485@end defmac
3486
3487@defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3488An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3489when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3490contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3491thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3492is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3493default value of this macro is zero.
3494@end defmac
3495
3496@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3497The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3498languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 75 words
3499with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
35008192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3501most machines.
3502@end defmac
3503
3504The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3505nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3506in the opposite case.
3507
3508@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3509The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3510instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3511stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3512checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3513default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3514systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3515@end defmac
3516
3517@defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3518GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3519represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3520space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3521You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3522use the default of four words.
3523@end defmac
3524
3525@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3526The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3527fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3528@option{-fstack-check}.
3529GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3530normally not need to override that default.
3531@end defmac
3532
3533@need 2000
3534@node Frame Registers
3535@subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3536
3537@c prevent bad page break with this line
3538This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3539
3540@defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3541The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3542fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3543the hardware determines which register this is.
3544@end defmac
3545
3546@defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3547The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3548access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3549hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3550choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3551@end defmac
3552
3553@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3554On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3555offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3556allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3557between these two locations). On those machines, define
3558@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3559be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3560@code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3561used for the frame pointer.
3562
3563You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3564is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3565the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3566completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3567definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3568@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3569or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3570
3571Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3572@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3573@end defmac
3574
3575@defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3576The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3577the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3578frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3579register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3580wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3581pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3582@code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3583(@pxref{Elimination}).
3584@end defmac
3585
e3339d0f
JM
3586@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3587Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3588@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3589the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3590== FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3591definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3592@end defmac
3593
3594@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3595Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3596@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3597same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3598ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3599definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3600@end defmac
3601
38f8b050
JR
3602@defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3603The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3604access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3605machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3606pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3607to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3608@code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3609
3610Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3611address from the stack.
3612@end defmac
3613
3614@defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3615@defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3616Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3617register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3618function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3619number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3620these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3621not be defined.
3622
3623The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3624
3625If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3626defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3627@end defmac
3628
3629@hook TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN
3630This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3631targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3632nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3633attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3634those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3635
3636The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3637
3638If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3639provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3640Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3641from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3642will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3643@findex stack_pointer_rtx
3644@findex frame_pointer_rtx
3645@findex arg_pointer_rtx
3646The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3647@code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3648to refer to those items.
3649@end deftypefn
3650
3651@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3652This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3653saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3654DWARF2 exception handling.
3655
3656Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3657exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3658extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3659in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3660used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3661routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3662registers that are not call-saved.
3663
3664If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3665@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3666@end defmac
3667
3668@defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3669
3670This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3671for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3672
3673If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3674@code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3675@end defmac
3676
3677@defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3678
3679Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3680is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3681Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3682column number to use instead.
3683
3684See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3685@end defmac
3686
3687@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3688
3689Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3690used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3691debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3692should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3693@code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3694
3695@end defmac
3696
3697@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3698
3699Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3700that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3701should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3702.eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3703return @code{@var{regno}}.
3704
3705@end defmac
3706
3707@node Elimination
3708@subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3709
3710@c prevent bad page break with this line
3711This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3712
3713@hook TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
3714This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3715a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3716value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3717
3718This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3719according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3720constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3721to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3722Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3723pointer.
3724
3725In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3726without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3727automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3728@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
3729them.
3730
3731In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3732register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3733fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3734
3735Default return value is @code{false}.
3736@end deftypefn
3737
3738@findex get_frame_size
3739@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3740A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3741between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3742the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3743such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3744registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3745
3746If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3747need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3748@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
3749case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3750@end defmac
3751
3752@defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3753If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3754eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3755defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3756references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3757
3758The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3759of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3760
3761On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3762the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3763must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3764replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3765depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3766
3767In this case, you might specify:
3768@smallexample
3769#define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3770@{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3771 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3772 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3773@end smallexample
3774
3775Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3776specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3777@end defmac
3778
3779@hook TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE
3780This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3781try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3782@var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3783is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
3784preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3785knows about.
3786
3787Default return value is @code{true}.
3788@end deftypefn
3789
3790@defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3791This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3792specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3793registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3794defined.
3795@end defmac
3796
3797@node Stack Arguments
3798@subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3799@cindex arguments on stack
3800@cindex stack arguments
3801
3802The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3803on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3804control passing certain arguments in registers.
3805
3806@hook TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3807This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3808prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3809passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3810cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3811The default is to not promote prototypes.
3812@end deftypefn
3813
3814@defmac PUSH_ARGS
3815A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3816outgoing arguments.
3817If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3818That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3819allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3820it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3821@end defmac
3822
3823@defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3824A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3825last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3826defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3827and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3828@end defmac
3829
3830@defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3831A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3832stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3833
3834On some machines, the definition
3835
3836@smallexample
3837#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3838@end smallexample
3839
3840@noindent
3841will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3842to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3843alignment. Then the definition should be
3844
3845@smallexample
3846#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3847@end smallexample
4a6336ad
JR
3848
3849It the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
38f8b050
JR
3850@end defmac
3851
3852@findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
3853@defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3854A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3855will be computed and placed into the variable
3856@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3857onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3858increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3859
3860Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3861is not proper.
3862@end defmac
3863
3864@defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3865Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3866allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3867registers.
3868
3869The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3870arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3871which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3872The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3873of the function.
3874
3875This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3876machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3877which.
3878@end defmac
3879@c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3880@c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3881
3882@defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3883Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3884caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3885when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3886if the function called is a library function.
3887
3888If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3889whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3890@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
3891@end defmac
3892
3893@defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3894Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3895stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3896@c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3897@c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3898
3899Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3900stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3901suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3902stack in its natural location.
3903@end defmac
3904
893d13d5 3905@hook TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS
38f8b050
JR
3906This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3907a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3908and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3909
3910@var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3911the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3912@code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3913From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3914
3915@var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3916describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3917@code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3918From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3919arguments (if known).
3920
3921When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3922will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3923you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3924by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3925a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3926in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3927
893d13d5 3928@var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
38f8b050
JR
3929stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3930argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3931
3932On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
893d13d5 3933of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
38f8b050
JR
3934calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3935the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3936convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3937arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3938nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3939@var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3940number of arguments.
3941@end deftypefn
3942
3943@defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3944A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3945pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3946when compiling a function call.
3947
3948@var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3949have been accumulated.
3950
3951On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3952that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3953that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3954call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3955appropriate.
3956@end defmac
3957
3958@node Register Arguments
3959@subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3960@cindex arguments in registers
3961@cindex registers arguments
3962
3963This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3964types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3965the stack.
3966
3967@defmac FUNCTION_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3968A C expression that controls whether a function argument is passed
3969in a register, and which register.
3970
3971The arguments are @var{cum}, which summarizes all the previous
3972arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3973the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3974(which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
3975which is 1 for an ordinary argument and 0 for nameless arguments that
3976correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called function's prototype.
3977@var{type} can be an incomplete type if a syntax error has previously
3978occurred.
3979
3980The value of the expression is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the
3981hard register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the
3982argument on the stack.
3983
3984For machines like the VAX and 68000, where normally all arguments are
3985pushed, zero suffices as a definition.
3986
3987The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
3988used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
3989@code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
3990@code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
3991describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
3992@code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3993register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3994register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
3995second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3996the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
3997As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
3998RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
3999argument is also stored on the stack.
4000
4001The last time this macro is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
4002VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
4003pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
4004
4005@cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
4006The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a machine
4007where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to cause
4008nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is done
4009by making @code{FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever @var{named} is 0.
4010
4011@cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4012@cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4013You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
4014in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
4015type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
4016is not defined and @code{FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
4017argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
4018defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
4019a register.
4020@end defmac
4021
4022@hook TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
4023This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
4024solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
4025definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
4026documentation.
4027@end deftypefn
4028
4029@defmac FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
4030Define this macro if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
4031that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
4032necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
4033argument.
4034
4035For such machines, @code{FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in which
4036the caller passes the value, and @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should
4037be defined in a similar fashion to tell the function being called
4038where the arguments will arrive.
4039
4040If @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined, @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4041serves both purposes.
4042@end defmac
4043
4044@hook TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES
4045This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4046argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
4047arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4048pushed on the stack.
4049
4050On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4051registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
4052first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
4053on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4054structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4055in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
4056compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
4057
4058@code{FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
4059register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
4060@code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
4061@end deftypefn
4062
ec9f85e5 4063@hook TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
38f8b050
JR
4064This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
4065position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
4066predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
4067passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
4068
4069If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
4070pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4071The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4072to that type.
4073@end deftypefn
4074
4075@hook TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES
4076The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4077known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4078function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4079by the caller.
4080
4081For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4082determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4083not be generated.
4084
4085The default version of this hook always returns false.
4086@end deftypefn
4087
4088@defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
4089A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument of
4090@code{FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some target machines,
4091the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number of bytes of
4092argument so far.
4093
4094There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4095arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4096variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4097arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4098@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4099should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4100@end defmac
4101
4102@defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4103If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4104function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4105created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4106reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4107If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4108@var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4109@end defmac
4110
4111@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4112A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4113@var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4114variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4115is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4116the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4117For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4118declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4119@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4120being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4121arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4122parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4123@var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4124
4125When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4126@var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4127contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4128an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4129macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4130never both of them at once.
4131@end defmac
4132
4133@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4134Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4135it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4136@code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4137is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
41380)} is used instead.
4139@end defmac
4140
4141@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4142Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4143finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4144undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4145
4146The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4147with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4148argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4149@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4150@c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4151@c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4152@end defmac
4153
4154@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
4155A C statement (sans semicolon) to update the summarizer variable
4156@var{cum} to advance past an argument in the argument list. The
4157values @var{mode}, @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument.
4158Once this is done, the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing
4159the @emph{following} argument with @code{FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
4160
4161This macro need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
4162on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4163used for arguments without any special help.
4164@end defmac
4165
4166@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4167If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4168offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4169which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4170slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4171top.
4172@end defmac
4173
4174@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4175If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4176to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4177@code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4178@code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4179
4180The @emph{amount} of padding is always just enough to reach the next
c2ed6cf8
NF
4181multiple of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY}; this macro does not
4182control it.
38f8b050
JR
4183
4184This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4185For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4186big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4187constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4188@end defmac
4189
4190@defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4191If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4192implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4193next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4194controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4195arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4196@end defmac
4197
4198@defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4199Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4200memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4201macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4202machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4203@code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4204registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4205a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4206required.
4207@end defmac
4208
c2ed6cf8
NF
4209@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY
4210This hook returns the the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
4211with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4212@code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4213@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
4214
4215@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4216A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4217register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4218@emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4219the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4220used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4221stack.
4222@end defmac
4223
4224@hook TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG
4225This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4226as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4227arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4228to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4229AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4230registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4231point register.
4232
4233The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4234false.
4235@end deftypefn
4236
4237@hook TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST
4238This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4239The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4240@end deftypefn
4241
07a5b2bc 4242@hook TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P
38f8b050
JR
4243This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4244to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4245variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
07a5b2bc 4246to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
38f8b050 4247variable.
07a5b2bc 4248The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
38f8b050
JR
4249this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4250internal type.
4251If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4252Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4253macro to iterate through all types.
4254@end deftypefn
4255
4256@hook TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST
4257This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4258@var{fndecl}.
4259The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4260@end deftypefn
4261
4262@hook TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE
4263This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4264type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4265@code{NULL_TREE}.
4266@end deftypefn
4267
4268@hook TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR
4269This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4270@code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4271arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4272@code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4273@end deftypefn
4274
4275@hook TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE
4276Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4277with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4278hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4279@end deftypefn
4280
4281@hook TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4282Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4283insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4284considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4285must work.
4286
4287The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4288required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4289Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4290code in @file{optabs.c}.
4291@end deftypefn
4292
4293@hook TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4294Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4295insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4296must have move patterns for this mode.
4297@end deftypefn
4298
4299@hook TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P
4300Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4301small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4302@var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4303in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4304In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4305for any mode.
4306
4307On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4308insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4309to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4310if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4311insn.
4312
4313Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4314in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4315the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4316classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4317registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4318registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4319SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4320strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4321machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4322
4323The default version of this hook retuns false for any mode. It is always
4324safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4325unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4326that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4327to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4328of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4329@end deftypefn
4330
4331@node Scalar Return
4332@subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4333@cindex return values in registers
4334@cindex values, returned by functions
4335@cindex scalars, returned as values
4336
4337This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4338values---values that can fit in registers.
4339
4340@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE
4341
4342Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4343returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4344representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4345representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4346function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4347compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4348Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4349a function returns a value.
4350
4351On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4352(Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4353place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4354@code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4355The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4356multiple places. See @code{FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
4357@code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4358location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4359the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4360that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4361port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4362@samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4363
4364If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4365the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4366@var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4367
4368If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4369node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4370pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4371convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4372known.
4373
4374Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4375which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4376the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4377different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4378
4379@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4380aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4381@code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4382@end deftypefn
4383
4384@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4385This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4386a new target instead.
4387@end defmac
4388
4389@defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4390A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4391function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4392
4393Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4394support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4395specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4396compiled.
4397@end defmac
4398
4399@hook TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE
4400Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4401function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4402
4403The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4404library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
4405representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4406
4407If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4408@end deftypefn
4409
4410@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4411A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4412register in which the values of called function may come back.
4413
4414A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4415second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4416recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4417suffices:
4418
4419@smallexample
4420#define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4421@end smallexample
4422
4423If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4424function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4425should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4426
4427This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4428for a new target instead.
4429@end defmac
4430
4431@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P
4432A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4433register in which the values of called function may come back.
4434
4435A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4436second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4437recognized by this target hook.
4438
4439If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4440function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4441should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4442
4443If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4444@end deftypefn
4445
4446@defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4447Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4448need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4449saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4450@end defmac
4451
4452@hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB
4453This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4454at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4455padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4456is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4457
4458Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4459be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4460or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
44614-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4462@code{SImode} rtx.
4463@end deftypefn
4464
4465@node Aggregate Return
4466@subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4467@cindex aggregates as return values
4468@cindex large return values
4469@cindex returning aggregate values
4470@cindex structure value address
4471
4472When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4473cases), the value is not returned according to
4474@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4475caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4476should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4477address}.
4478
4479This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4480memory.
4481
4482@hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY
4483This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4484function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4485Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4486will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4487libcalls.
4488
4489Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4490by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4491takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4492possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4493definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4494values, and 0 otherwise.
4495
4496Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4497be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4498to indicate this.
4499@end deftypefn
4500
4501@defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4502Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4503in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4504only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4505If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4506and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4507target hook.
4508
4509If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4510@end defmac
4511
4512@hook TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX
4513This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4514address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4515passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4516be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4517hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4518argument.
4519
4520On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4521is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4522caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4523be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4524@var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4525the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4526the caller.
4527
4528If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4529stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4530@var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4531structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4532to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4533@end deftypefn
4534
4535@defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4536Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4537for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4538the address of a static variable containing the value.
4539
4540Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4541pass an address to the subroutine.
4542
4543This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4544nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4545@end defmac
4546
ffa88471
SE
4547@hook TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE
4548
4549@hook TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE
4550
38f8b050
JR
4551@node Caller Saves
4552@subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4553
4554If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4555makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4556must live across calls.
4557
4558@defmac CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
4559A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
4560a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
4561restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
4562this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
4563
4564If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
4565machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
4566@end defmac
4567
4568@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4569A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4570of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4571@var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4572returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4573will select the smallest suitable mode.
4574@end defmac
4575
4576@node Function Entry
4577@subsection Function Entry and Exit
4578@cindex function entry and exit
4579@cindex prologue
4580@cindex epilogue
4581
4582This section describes the macros that output function entry
4583(@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4584
4585@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE
4586If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4587function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4588initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4589saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4590local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4591stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4592
4593The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4594macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4595
4596@findex regs_ever_live
4597To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4598@code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4599@var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4600prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4601call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4602@code{regs_ever_live}.)
4603
4604On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4605not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4606they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4607appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4608registers are used in the function.
4609
4610@findex frame_pointer_needed
4611On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4612function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4613pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4614frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4615@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4616time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4617
4618The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4619required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4620listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4621order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4622stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4623the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4624for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4625compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4626or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4627need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4628@end deftypefn
4629
4630@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE
4631If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4632prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4633emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4634emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4635@end deftypefn
4636
4637@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE
4638If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4639epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4640emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4641emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4642@end deftypefn
4643
4644@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE
4645If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4646function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4647registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4648called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4649same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4650registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4651@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4652
4653On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4654of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4655instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4656@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4657
4658Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4659@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4660switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4661define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4662target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4663condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4664
4665On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4666function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4667two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4668is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4669@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4670a function that needs a frame pointer.
4671
4672Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4673@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4674The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4675function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4676
4677On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4678others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4679given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4680number of arguments.
4681
4682@findex current_function_pops_args
4683Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4684functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4685needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4686function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4687@code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4688@end deftypefn
4689
4690@itemize @bullet
4691@item
4692@findex current_function_pretend_args_size
4693A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
4694uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4695stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4696if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4697arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4698yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4699region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4700registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4701features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4702
4703@item
4704An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4705The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4706the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4707machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4708in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4709a save area.
4710
4711@item
4712A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4713boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4714this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4715save area closer to the top of the stack.
4716
4717@item
4718@cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4719Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4720@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4721argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4722@end itemize
4723
4724@defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4725Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4726instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4727pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4728adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4729default is 0.
4730
4731Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4732frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4733stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4734compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4735@end defmac
4736
4737@defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4738Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4739used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4740pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4741@end defmac
4742
4743@defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4744Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4745used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4746on entry to an exception edge.
4747@end defmac
4748
4749@defmac DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
4750Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
4751instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''. The
4752definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
4753representing the number of delay slots there.
4754@end defmac
4755
4756@defmac ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
4757A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
4758slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
4759
4760The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
4761being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
4762eligibility). It is never negative and is always less than the number
4763of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
4764If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
4765may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot. Also, other insns may
4766(at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
4767slot.
4768
4769@findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
4770@findex final_scan_insn
4771The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
4772list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
4773@code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}. The insn for the first
4774delay slot comes first in the list. Your definition of the macro
4775@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
4776outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
4777@code{final_scan_insn}.
4778
4779You need not define this macro if you did not define
4780@code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
4781@end defmac
4782
4783@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4784A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4785function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4786inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4787adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4788the real function.
4789
4790First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4791contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4792contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4793in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4794e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4795all other incoming arguments.
4796
4797Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4798made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4799adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4800
4801@smallexample
4802p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4803@end smallexample
4804
4805After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4806@code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4807not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4808return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4809
4810The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4811the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4812of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4813and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4814
4815The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4816have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4817some targets, but probably not.
4818
4819If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4820front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4821@var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4822not support varargs.
4823@end deftypefn
4824
4825@hook TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4826A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4827to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4828arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4829generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4830previously exposed.
4831@end deftypefn
4832
4833@node Profiling
4834@subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4835@cindex profiling, code generation
4836
4837These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4838
4839@defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4840A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4841assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4842
4843@findex mcount
4844The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4845your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4846compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4847compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4848
4849Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4850variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4851@samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4852the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4853@end defmac
4854
4855@defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4856A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4857code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4858not support profiling.
4859@end defmac
4860
4861@defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4862Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4863@code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4864allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4865implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4866@var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4867@end defmac
4868
4869@defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4870Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4871the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4872@end defmac
4873
4874@node Tail Calls
4875@subsection Permitting tail calls
4876@cindex tail calls
4877
4878@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
4879True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4880call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4881or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4882
4883It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4884tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4885during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4886as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4887``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4888may vary greatly between different architectures.
4889@end deftypefn
4890
4891@hook TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY
4892Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4893function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4894cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4895registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4896TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4897FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4898@end deftypefn
4899
4900@node Stack Smashing Protection
4901@subsection Stack smashing protection
4902@cindex stack smashing protection
4903
4904@hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD
4905This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4906for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
4907runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4908that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4909variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4910
4911The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4912@samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4913@end deftypefn
4914
4915@hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL
4916This hook returns a tree expression that alerts the runtime that the
4917stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
4918involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4919
4920The default version of this hook invokes a function called
4921@samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
4922normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4923@end deftypefn
4924
7458026b
ILT
4925@hook TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK
4926
38f8b050
JR
4927@node Varargs
4928@section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4929@cindex varargs implementation
4930
4931GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4932@code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4933on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4934varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4935conditionals to include it.
4936
4937ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4938the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
4939implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4940to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
4941@code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
4942supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4943
4944However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
4945the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4946below.
4947
4948@defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
4949Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
4950that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
4951versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
4952you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
4953
4954On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
4955control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
4956other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
4957found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4958
4959Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4960beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4961@code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4962This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4963to use them for its own purposes.
4964@c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
4965@c 10feb93
4966@end defmac
4967
38f8b050 4968@defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
c59a0a1d 4969This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
38f8b050
JR
4970argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
4971returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
4972argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
4973fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
4974verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
4975of the current function.
4976@end defmac
4977
4978@defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
4979Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
4980passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
4981has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
4982specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
4983with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
4984
4985@code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
4986considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
4987kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
4988
4989The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
4990interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
4991@end defmac
4992
4993These machine description macros help implement varargs:
4994
4995@hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS
4996If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
4997@code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
4998beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
4999return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
5000to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
5001@end deftypefn
5002
5003@hook TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
5004This target hook offers an alternative to using
5005@code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5006@code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
5007register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5008have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
5009use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5010pass all their arguments on the stack.
5011
5012The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
5013structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
5014named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5015last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5016
5017The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5018argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5019store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5020variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
5021store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5022frame.
5023
5024Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5025compile time without knowing their data types,
5026@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5027have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5028for all data types.
5029
5030If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5031arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5032happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5033end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5034not generate any instructions in this case.
5035@end deftypefn
5036
5037@hook TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
5038Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5039argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5040
5041This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
5042is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5043@code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5044arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5045but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5046then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5047except the last are treated as named.
5048
5049You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5050@end deftypefn
5051
5052@hook TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
5053If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5054@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5055@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5056defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5057@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5058Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5059@end deftypefn
5060
5061@node Trampolines
5062@section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5063@cindex trampolines for nested functions
5064@cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5065
5066A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5067when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5068the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
5069tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5070trampoline.
5071
5072The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5073address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5074the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5075two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5076exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5077machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5078two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5079operands.
5080
5081The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5082parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5083immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5084simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5085proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5086may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5087separately.
5088
5089@hook TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE
5090This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5091on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5092the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5093label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5094
5095If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5096for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5097code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5098to generate it on the spot.
5099@end deftypefn
5100
5101@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5102Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5103(@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5104@end defmac
5105
5106@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5107A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5108@end defmac
5109
5110@defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5111Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5112
5113If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5114is used for aligning trampolines.
5115@end defmac
5116
5117@hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT
5118This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5119@var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5120is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5121RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5122when it is called.
5123
5124If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5125first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5126from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5127Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5128trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5129to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5130
5131If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5132enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5133initializing the trampoline proper.
5134@end deftypefn
5135
5136@hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS
5137This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5138the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5139memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5140the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5141address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5142be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5143If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5144@end deftypefn
5145
5146Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5147separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5148fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5149jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5150
5151Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5152the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5153make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5154subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5155latter makes initialization faster.
5156
5157To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5158the following macro.
5159
5160@defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5161If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5162cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5163typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5164@var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5165@end defmac
5166
5167The operating system may also require the stack to be made executable
5168before calling the trampoline. To implement this requirement, define
5169the following macro.
5170
5171@defmac ENABLE_EXECUTE_STACK
5172Define this macro if certain operations must be performed before executing
5173code located on the stack. The macro should expand to a series of C
5174file-scope constructs (e.g.@: functions) and provide a unique entry point
5175named @code{__enable_execute_stack}. The target is responsible for
5176emitting calls to the entry point in the code, for example from the
5177@code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT} hook.
5178@end defmac
5179
5180To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5181you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5182cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5183beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5184its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5185
5186@defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5187Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5188work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5189which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5190@code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5191
5192If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5193C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5194special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5195statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5196global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5197special assembler code.
5198@end defmac
5199
5200@node Library Calls
5201@section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5202@cindex library subroutine names
5203@cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5204
5205@c prevent bad page break with this line
5206Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5207
5208@defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5209This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5210expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5211provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5212are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5213@end defmac
5214
5215@findex set_optab_libfunc
5216@findex init_one_libfunc
5217@hook TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS
5218This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5219existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5220@code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5221@code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5222library routines.
5223
5224The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5225@end deftypefn
5226
5227@defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5228This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5229implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5230mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5231return a tristate.
5232
5233GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5234comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5235don't need to define this macro.
5236@end defmac
5237
5238@defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5239This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5240functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5241operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5242and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5243If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5244@minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5245in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5246@end defmac
5247
5248@cindex US Software GOFAST, floating point emulation library
5249@cindex floating point emulation library, US Software GOFAST
5250@cindex GOFAST, floating point emulation library
5251@findex gofast_maybe_init_libfuncs
5252@defmac US_SOFTWARE_GOFAST
5253Define this macro if your system C library uses the US Software GOFAST
5254library to provide floating point emulation.
5255
5256In addition to defining this macro, your architecture must set
5257@code{TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS} to @code{gofast_maybe_init_libfuncs}, or
5258else call that function from its version of that hook. It is defined
5259in @file{config/gofast.h}, which must be included by your
5260architecture's @file{@var{cpu}.c} file. See @file{sparc/sparc.c} for
5261an example.
5262
5263If this macro is defined, the
5264@code{TARGET_FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL} target hook must return
5265false for @code{SFmode} and @code{DFmode} comparisons.
5266@end defmac
5267
5268@cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5269@findex matherr
5270@defmac TARGET_EDOM
5271The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5272expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5273deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5274@file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5275system.
5276
5277If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5278domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5279error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5280there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5281that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5282@end defmac
5283
5284@cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5285@defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5286Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5287refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5288@code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5289macro, a reasonable default is used.
5290@end defmac
5291
5292@cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
5293@defmac TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
5294When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
5295@code{sinf} and similarly for other functions defined by C99 standard. The
5296default is zero because a number of existing systems lack support for these
5297functions in their runtime so this macro needs to be redefined to one on
5298systems that do support the C99 runtime.
5299@end defmac
5300
5301@cindex sincos math function, implicit usage
5302@defmac TARGET_HAS_SINCOS
5303When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize calls to @code{sin}
5304and @code{cos} with the same argument to a call to @code{sincos}. The
5305default is zero. The target has to provide the following functions:
5306@smallexample
5307void sincos(double x, double *sin, double *cos);
5308void sincosf(float x, float *sin, float *cos);
5309void sincosl(long double x, long double *sin, long double *cos);
5310@end smallexample
5311@end defmac
5312
5313@defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5314Define this macro to generate code for Objective-C message sending using
5315the calling convention of the NeXT system. This calling convention
5316involves passing the object, the selector and the method arguments all
5317at once to the method-lookup library function.
5318
5319The default calling convention passes just the object and the selector
5320to the lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5321@end defmac
5322
5323@node Addressing Modes
5324@section Addressing Modes
5325@cindex addressing modes
5326
5327@c prevent bad page break with this line
5328This is about addressing modes.
5329
5330@defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5331@defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5332@defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5333@defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5334A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5335pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5336@end defmac
5337
5338@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5339@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5340A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5341post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5342the size of the memory operand.
5343@end defmac
5344
5345@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5346@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5347A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5348post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5349@end defmac
5350
5351@defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5352A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5353is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5354@code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5355is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5356constant addresses are supported.
5357@end defmac
5358
5359@defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5360@code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5361accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5362known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5363expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5364@code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5365@end defmac
5366
5367@defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5368A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5369memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5370the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5371accept.
5372@end defmac
5373
5374@hook TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
5375A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5376address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5377
5378Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5379non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5380desired by the caller.
5381
5382The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5383that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5384considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5385kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5386must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5387up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5388register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5389if the array holds @code{-1}.
5390
5391The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5392accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5393register is required.
5394
5395Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5396and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5397constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5398specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5399recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5400
5401Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5402sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5403@code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5404naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5405be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5406
5407@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5408On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5409the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5410target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5411into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5412@code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5413@code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5414Format}.
5415
5416@cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5417Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5418this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5419has this syntax:
5420
5421@example
5422#define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5423@end example
5424
5425@noindent
5426and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5427address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
6f7b223b
PK
5428
5429@findex REG_OK_STRICT
5430Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5431macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5432@code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5433that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5434
38f8b050
JR
5435Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5436files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5437@end deftypefn
5438
5439@defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5440A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5441character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5442letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5443@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5444support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5445semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5446preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5447@code{'m'} constraint.
5448@end defmac
5449
5450@defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5451A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5452or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5453can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5454@code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5455
5456It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5457that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5458
5459The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5460a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5461@end defmac
5462
5463@hook TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5464This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5465operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5466address.
5467
5468@findex break_out_memory_refs
5469@var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5470and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5471@var{x}.
5472
5473The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5474@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5475should return the new @var{x}.
5476
5477It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address.
5478The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, it
5479is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5480a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5481strategy can generate better code.
5482@end deftypefn
5483
5484@defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5485A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5486that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5487@var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5488It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5489performance reasons.
5490
5491For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5492reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5493registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5494processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5495needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5496@code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5497generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5498be shared.
5499
5500@emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5501to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5502and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5503of reload internals.
5504
5505@emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5506previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5507then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5508
5509@findex push_reload
5510The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5511need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5512suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5513
5514The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5515@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5516should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5517This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5518@code{push_reload}.
5519
5520@findex strict_memory_address_p
5521The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5522the address has become legitimate.
5523
5524@findex copy_rtx
5525If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5526this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5527single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5528top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5529It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5530address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5531@end defmac
5532
5533@hook TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P
5534This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} can have
5535different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5536reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5537but not others.
5538
5539Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5540effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5541of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5542addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5543
5544You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5545
5546The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5547@end deftypefn
5548
5549@defmac GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS (@var{addr}, @var{label})
5550A C statement or compound statement with a conditional @code{goto
5551@var{label};} executed if memory address @var{x} (an RTX) can have
5552different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5553reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5554but not others.
5555
5556Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5557effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5558of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5559addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5560
5561You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5562
5563These are obsolete macros, replaced by the
5564@code{TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P} target hook.
5565@end defmac
5566
5567@defmac LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5568A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for
5569an immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5570@var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this. In fact,
5571@samp{1} is a suitable definition for this macro on machines where
5572anything @code{CONSTANT_P} is valid.
5573@end defmac
5574
5575@hook TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5576This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5577@code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5578macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5579references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5580addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5581the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5582into their original form.
5583@end deftypefn
5584
5585@hook TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM
5586This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5587should not) be spilled to the constant pool. The default version of
5588this hook returns false.
5589
5590The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5591deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5592from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5593holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5594of TLS symbols for various targets.
5595@end deftypefn
5596
5597@hook TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P
5598This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5599be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5600of @var{x}.
5601
5602The default version returns false for all constants.
5603@end deftypefn
5604
89356d17 5605@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL
38f8b050
JR
5606This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
5607the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5608@code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. @var{md_fn} is true
5609when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function. When
5610@var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5611of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5612function are valid.
5613@end deftypefn
5614
5615@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD
5616This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5617address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5618used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5619@var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5620
5621The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5622@var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5623the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5624@code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5625two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5626@var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5627the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5628from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5629@var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5630@var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5631@var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5632
5633If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5634to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5635use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5636@code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5637should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5638described above.
5639If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5640the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5641log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5642@end deftypefn
5643
5644@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN
5645This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5646widening multiplication of the even elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5647
5648If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5649@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD} target hook when vectorizing
5650widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5651preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5652@code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5653@end deftypefn
5654
5655@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD
5656This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5657widening multiplication of the odd elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5658
5659If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5660@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN} target hook when vectorizing
5661widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5662preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5663@code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5664@end deftypefn
5665
5666@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST
5667Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
720f5239
IR
5668For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
5669misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
38f8b050
JR
5670@end deftypefn
5671
5672@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE
5673Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5674@end deftypefn
5675
5676@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM
5677Target builtin that implements vector permute.
5678@end deftypefn
5679
5680@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM_OK
5681Return true if a vector created for @code{builtin_vec_perm} is valid.
5682@end deftypefn
5683
5684@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION
5685This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5686input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5687The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5688specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5689(truncation, rounding, etc.).
5690
5691If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5692@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5693conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5694@end deftypefn
5695
5696@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION
5697This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5698vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5699@var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5700The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration. The
5701return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5702@var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5703@end deftypefn
5704
5705@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT
5706This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5707store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5708parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5709the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5710parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5711@end deftypefn
5712
cc4b5170
RG
5713@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE
5714This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5715mode @var{mode}. The default is
5716equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
26983c22
L
5717transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5718@end deftypefn
5719
767f865f
RG
5720@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES
5721This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5722after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5723mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5724The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5725@end deftypefn
5726
38f8b050
JR
5727@node Anchored Addresses
5728@section Anchored Addresses
5729@cindex anchored addresses
5730@cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5731
5732GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5733For example, if we have:
5734
5735@smallexample
5736static int a, b, c;
5737int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5738@end smallexample
5739
5740the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5741addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5742it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5743the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5744be something like:
5745
5746@smallexample
5747int foo (void)
5748@{
5749 register int *xr = &x;
5750 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5751@}
5752@end smallexample
5753
5754(which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5755``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5756
5757The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5758in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5759section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5760or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5761
5762@hook TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5763The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5764On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5765applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5766for every mode. The default value is 0.
5767@end deftypevr
5768
5769@hook TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5770Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5771offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5772value is 0.
5773@end deftypevr
5774
5775@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR
5776Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5777@code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5778The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5779of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5780
5781If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5782it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5783If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5784is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5785@end deftypefn
5786
5787@hook TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P
5788Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5789@var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5790@samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5791
5792The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5793intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5794or target-specific sections.
5795@end deftypefn
5796
5797@node Condition Code
5798@section Condition Code Status
5799@cindex condition code status
5800
5801The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5802two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5803
5804The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5805(@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5806clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5807register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5808architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5809most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5810most RISC machines.
5811
5812The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5813the definition and use of the condition code, which need to be in adjacent
5814insns for machines using @code{(cc0)}. This can prevent important
5815optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5816is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5817three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5818scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5819separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5820
5821For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5822represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5823condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5824condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5825or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5826Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5827that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5828
5829Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5830specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5831interested in most macros in this section.
5832
5833@menu
5834* CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5835* MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
5836* Cond. Exec. Macros:: Macros to control conditional execution.
5837@end menu
5838
5839@node CC0 Condition Codes
5840@subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5841@findex cc0
5842
5843@findex cc_status
5844The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5845describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5846the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5847variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5848currently based, and several standard flags.
5849
5850Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5851description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5852information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5853
5854@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
5855C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5856component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5857
5858This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5859@end defmac
5860
5861@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5862A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5863The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5864the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5865define this macro to initialize it.
5866
5867This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5868@end defmac
5869
5870@defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5871A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5872appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5873this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5874code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5875set @code{(cc0)}.
5876
5877This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5878
5879If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5880other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5881invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5882reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5883registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5884@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5885insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5886based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5887value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5888this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5889@samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5890@code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5891condition code value.
5892
5893The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5894with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5895@code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5896constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5897insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5898@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5899@code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5900
5901A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5902that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5903@samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5904two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5905@end defmac
5906
5907@node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5908@subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5909@findex CCmode
5910@findex MODE_CC
5911
5912@defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5913On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
5914than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
5915code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
5916when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
5917bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
5918branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
5919this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
5920record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
5921also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
5922unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
5923
5924If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
5925@file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
5926a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
5927have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
5928by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
5929be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
5930the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
5931
5932@smallexample
5933(define_insn ""
5934 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
5935 (compare:CC_NOOV
5936 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
5937 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
5938 (const_int 0)))]
5939 ""
5940 "@dots{}")
5941@end smallexample
5942
5943@noindent
5944together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
5945for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
5946
5947@smallexample
5948#define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
5949 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
5950 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
5951 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
5952 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
5953 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
5954@end smallexample
5955
5956Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
5957were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
5958this section.
5959
5960You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
5961in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
5962@end defmac
5963
5964@defmac CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
5965On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
5966convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
5967does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
5968comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
5969
5970On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
5971required conversions. @var{code} is the initial comparison code
5972and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
5973comparison, respectively. You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
5974@var{op1} as required.
5975
5976GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
5977valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
5978@file{md} file.
5979
5980You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
5981code or operands.
5982@end defmac
5983
5984@defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
5985A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
5986comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
5987can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
5988then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
5989
5990You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
5991floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
5992For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
5993inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
5994
5995@smallexample
5996#define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
5997@end smallexample
5998@end defmac
5999
6000@defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
6001A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6002comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
6003@code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
6004machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
6005instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
6006freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
6007like:
6008
6009@smallexample
6010#define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
6011 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
6012 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6013@end smallexample
6014@end defmac
6015
6016@hook TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS
6017On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6018register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6019regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6020hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6021small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6022to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6023arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6024When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6025integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6026@code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6027
6028The default version of this hook returns false.
6029@end deftypefn
6030
6031@hook TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE
6032On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6033@code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6034validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6035target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6036both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6037return @code{VOIDmode}.
6038
6039The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6040same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6041returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6042@end deftypefn
6043
6044@node Cond. Exec. Macros
6045@subsection Macros to control conditional execution
6046@findex conditional execution
6047@findex predication
6048
6049There is one macro that may need to be defined for targets
6050supporting conditional execution, independent of how they
6051represent conditional branches.
6052
6053@defmac REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (@var{op1}, @var{op2})
6054A C expression that returns true if the conditional execution predicate
6055@var{op1}, a comparison operation, is the inverse of @var{op2} and vice
6056versa. Define this to return 0 if the target has conditional execution
6057predicates that cannot be reversed safely. There is no need to validate
6058that the arguments of op1 and op2 are the same, this is done separately.
6059If no expansion is specified, this macro is defined as follows:
6060
6061@smallexample
6062#define REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (x, y) \
6063 (GET_CODE ((x)) == reversed_comparison_code ((y), NULL))
6064@end smallexample
6065@end defmac
6066
6067@node Costs
6068@section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6069@cindex costs of instructions
6070@cindex relative costs
6071@cindex speed of instructions
6072
6073These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6074on the target machine.
6075
6076@defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6077A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6078register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6079expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6080value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6081that.
6082
6083It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6084same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6085registers if they are not general registers.
6086
6087If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6088hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6089classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6090constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6091allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6092if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6093
6094These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6095@code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6096@end defmac
6097
6098@hook TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST
6099This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6100from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6101are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6102A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6103that.
6104
6105It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6106same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6107registers if they are not general registers.
6108
6109If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6110hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6111classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6112constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6113allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6114if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6115
6116The default version of this function returns 2.
6117@end deftypefn
6118
6119@defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6120A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6121register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6122is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6123is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6124registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6125should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6126
6127If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6128the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6129needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6130between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6131more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6132reflect the actual cost of the move.
6133
6134GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6135secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6136a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6137secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
61384 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6139value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6140are the same as to this macro.
6141
6142These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6143@code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6144@end defmac
6145
911852ff 6146@hook TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST
38f8b050 6147This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
911852ff 6148between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
38f8b050
JR
6149if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6150This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6151If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6152registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6153
6154If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6155the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6156needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
911852ff 6157between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
38f8b050
JR
6158more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6159reflect the actual cost of the move.
6160
6161GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6162secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6163a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6164secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
61654 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6166value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6167are the same as to this target hook.
6168@end deftypefn
6169
6170@defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
6171A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is the
6172default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter @var{speed_p}
6173is true when the branch in question should be optimized for speed. When
6174it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should be returning value optimal for code size
6175rather then performance considerations. @var{predictable_p} is true for well
6176predictable branches. On many architectures the @code{BRANCH_COST} can be
6177reduced then.
6178@end defmac
6179
6180Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6181but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6182ordinarily expect.
6183
6184@defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6185Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6186than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6187faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6188require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6189between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6190
6191When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6192finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6193load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6194faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6195may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6196other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6197@end defmac
6198
6199@defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6200Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6201@var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6202than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6203handler.
6204
6205When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6206@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6207moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6208Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6209cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6210
6211If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
6212this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6213@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6214@end defmac
6215
6216@defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6217The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6218which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6219string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6220make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6221
6222Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6223@code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6224the number of such sequences.
6225
6226The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6227optimized for speed rather than size.
6228
6229If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6230@end defmac
6231
6232@defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6233A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
6234copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
6235will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6236than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6237@end defmac
6238
6239@defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6240A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6241a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6242@end defmac
6243
6244@defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6245The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6246of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6247or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6248eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6249
6250The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6251optimized for speed rather than size.
6252
6253If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6254@end defmac
6255
6256@defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6257A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
6258to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
6259will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6260than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
6261@end defmac
6262
6263@defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6264The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6265of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6266a block set insn or a library call.
6267Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6268eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6269
6270The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6271optimized for speed rather than size.
6272
6273If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6274@end defmac
6275
6276@defmac SET_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6277A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6278used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some
6279other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when
6280storing values other than constant zero.
6281Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6282than @code{SET_RATIO}.
6283@end defmac
6284
6285@defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6286A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6287used to set a chunk of memory to a constant string value, or whether some
6288other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
6289called with a constant source string.
6290Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6291than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6292@end defmac
6293
6294@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6295A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6296thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6297@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6298@end defmac
6299
6300@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6301A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6302thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6303@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6304@end defmac
6305
6306@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6307A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6308thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6309@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6310@end defmac
6311
6312@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6313A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6314thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6315@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6316@end defmac
6317
6318@defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6319A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6320thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6321@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6322@end defmac
6323
6324@defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6325A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6326thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6327@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6328@end defmac
6329
6330@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6331This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6332thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6333@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6334@end defmac
6335
6336@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6337This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6338thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6339@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6340@end defmac
6341
6342@defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6343Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
6344function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6345@end defmac
6346
6347@defmac RANGE_TEST_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6348Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6349@samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6350@code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6351@end defmac
6352
6353@hook TARGET_RTX_COSTS
6354This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6355
6356The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6357available for examination in @var{x}, and the rtx code of the expression
6358in which it is contained, found in @var{outer_code}. @var{code} is the
6359expression code---redundant, since it can be obtained with
6360@code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
6361
6362In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6363@code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6364instructions.
6365
6366On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6367for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6368necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6369for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6370operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6371
6372When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6373false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6374size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6375
6376The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6377processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6378@end deftypefn
6379
6380@hook TARGET_ADDRESS_COST
6381This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6382@var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6383the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6384
6385For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6386true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6387instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6388all addresses will have equal costs.
6389
6390In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6391the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6392cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6393
6394For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6395and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6396is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6397references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6398the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6399that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6400instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6401specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6402
6403This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6404
6405On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6406cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6407@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6408be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6409@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6410should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6411should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6412registers on machines with lots of registers.
6413@end deftypefn
6414
6415@node Scheduling
6416@section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6417
6418The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6419adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6420hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6421them: try the first ones in this list first.
6422
6423@hook TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE
6424This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6425issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6426Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6427an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6428constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6429hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6430This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6431it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6432@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6433@end deftypefn
6434
6435@hook TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE
6436This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6437from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
6438still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6439@samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6440@code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6441You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6442than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6443@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6444debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6445@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6446was scheduled.
6447@end deftypefn
6448
6449@hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST
6450This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6451relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6452dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6453is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6454to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
6455that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
6456data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6457description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6458output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6459times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6460acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
6461@pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6462@end deftypefn
6463
6464@hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY
6465This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6466@var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6467execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6468later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6469scheduling priorities of insns.
6470@end deftypefn
6471
6472@hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER
6473This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6474list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6475combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6476@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6477debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6478@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6479list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6480a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6481reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6482@var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
6483is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6484the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6485can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6486@samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6487@end deftypefn
6488
6489@hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2
6490Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6491function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6492is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6493@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6494return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6495this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6496scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6497cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6498@end deftypefn
6499
6500@hook TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK
6501This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6502chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6503correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6504example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6505analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6506dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6507calculated.
6508@end deftypefn
6509
6510@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT
6511This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6512instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6513pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6514is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6515@var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6516region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
6517scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6518@end deftypefn
6519
6520@hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH
6521This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6522instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6523cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6524is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6525to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6526@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6527@end deftypefn
6528
6529@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL
6530This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6531@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6532@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6533@var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6534@end deftypefn
6535
6536@hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL
6537This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6538@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6539@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6540@end deftypefn
6541
6542@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6543The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6544pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6545when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6546simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6547processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6548based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6549when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6550@end deftypefn
6551
6552@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6553The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6554@end deftypefn
6555
6556@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6557The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6558to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6559simulated processor cycle finishes.
6560@end deftypefn
6561
6562@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6563The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6564used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6565@end deftypefn
6566
6567@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6568The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6569The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6570to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6571state on a single insn is not enough.
6572@end deftypefn
6573
6574@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6575The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6576The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6577to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6578state on a single insn is not enough.
6579@end deftypefn
6580
6581@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD
6582This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6583for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6584chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6585value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6586@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6587subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6588maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6589@acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6590packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6591rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6592
6593This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6594processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6595with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6596@var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6597@var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6598processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6599@var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6600until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6601the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6602
6603Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6604pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6605schedules to choose the best one.
6606
6607The default is no multipass scheduling.
6608@end deftypefn
6609
6610@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD
6611
6612This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6613considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
6614zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be not chosen to
6615be issued.
6616
6617The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6618@end deftypefn
6619
894fd6f2
MK
6620@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN
6621This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6622scheduling.
6623@end deftypefn
6624
6625@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE
6626This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6627@end deftypefn
6628
6629@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK
6630This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6631an instruction.
6632@end deftypefn
6633
6634@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END
6635This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6636round of multipass scheduling.
6637@end deftypefn
6638
6639@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT
6640This hook initilizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6641@end deftypefn
6642
6643@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI
6644This hook finilizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6645@end deftypefn
6646
c06bbdf7 6647@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE
38f8b050
JR
6648This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6649on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6650@var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6651the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6652is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6653start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6654verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6655@var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6656processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6657and the current processor cycle.
6658@end deftypefn
6659
6660@hook TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE
6661This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6662the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6663are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
6664to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6665being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6666dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6667parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6668The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6669insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6670and @code{false} otherwise.
6671
6672Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6673where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6674delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6675that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6676important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6677closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
6678not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6679@end deftypefn
6680
6681@hook TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED
6682This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6683the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6684per instruction data structures.
6685@end deftypefn
6686
6687@hook TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT
6688Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6689@end deftypefn
6690
6691@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT
6692Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6693It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6694beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6695@end deftypefn
6696
6697@hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT
6698Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6699@end deftypefn
6700
6701@hook TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT
6702Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6703@end deftypefn
6704
6705@hook TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT
6706Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6707@end deftypefn
6708
6709@hook TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN
6710This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6711speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6712The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6713version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6714pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6715or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
6716speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6717the generated speculative pattern.
6718@end deftypefn
6719
6720@hook TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P
6721This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6722for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6723instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6724@end deftypefn
6725
6726@hook TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK
6727This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6728check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6729speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6730@var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6731be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6732recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6733a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6734@var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6735@end deftypefn
6736
6737@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD_SPEC
6738This hook is used as a workaround for
6739@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD} not being
6740called on the first instruction of the ready list. The hook is used to
6741discard speculative instructions that stand first in the ready list from
6742being scheduled on the current cycle. If the hook returns @code{false},
6743@var{insn} will not be chosen to be issued.
6744For non-speculative instructions,
6745the hook should always return @code{true}. For example, in the ia64 backend
6746the hook is used to cancel data speculative insns when the ALAT table
6747is nearly full.
6748@end deftypefn
6749
6750@hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS
6751This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6752enabled/used.
6753The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
6754The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6755@end deftypefn
6756
6757@hook TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII
6758This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6759resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6760the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6761backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6762bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6763of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6764@end deftypefn
6765
7942e47e
RY
6766@hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH
6767This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6768is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6769@end deftypefn
6770
6771@hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO
6772This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
6773in its second parameter.
6774@end deftypefn
6775
38f8b050
JR
6776@node Sections
6777@section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6778@c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6779@c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6780
6781An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6782data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6783section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6784section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6785section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
6786of sections.
6787
6788@file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6789@code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6790The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6791is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6792as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6793initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6794They may however depend on command-line flags.
6795
6796@emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6797use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6798to be string literals.
6799
6800Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6801section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
6802should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6803@code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6804
6805You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6806@code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6807in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
6808@code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
6809create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6810reuse @code{text_section}.
6811
6812All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6813if the target does not provide them.
6814
6815@defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6816A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6817assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6818Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
6819@end defmac
6820
6821@defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6822If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6823frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
6824a default definition if the target supports named sections.
6825@end defmac
6826
6827@defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6828If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6829executed functions in the program.
6830@end defmac
6831
6832@defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6833A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6834assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6835data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
6836@end defmac
6837
6838@defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6839If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6840containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6841initialized, writable small data.
6842@end defmac
6843
6844@defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6845A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6846assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6847data.
6848@end defmac
6849
6850@defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6851If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6852containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6853uninitialized global data. If not defined, and neither
6854@code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} nor @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} are defined,
6855uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
6856@option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
6857used.
6858@end defmac
6859
6860@defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6861If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6862containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6863uninitialized, writable small data.
6864@end defmac
6865
6866@defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
6867If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
6868assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
6869common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
6870@end defmac
6871
6872@defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
6873If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
6874containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
6875default is @code{'T'}.
6876@end defmac
6877
6878@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6879If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6880containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6881initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6882not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6883variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6884@end defmac
6885
6886@defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
6887If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6888containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6889finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6890not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6891variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6892@end defmac
6893
6894@defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6895If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6896containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6897part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6898defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6899both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6900@end defmac
6901
6902@defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6903If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6904containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6905part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6906defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6907both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6908@end defmac
6909
6910@defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
6911If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
6912via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
6913the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
6914@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
6915to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
6916sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
6917ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
6918registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
6919constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
6920@end defmac
6921
6922@defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
6923If defined, a string which names the section into which small
6924variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
6925when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
6926you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
6927they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
6928expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
6929MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
6930require small data support from your application, but use this macro
6931to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
6932access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
6933@end defmac
6934
6935@defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
6936If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
6937arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
6938@code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
6939and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
6940@end defmac
6941
6942@defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
6943Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
6944tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
6945section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
6946readonly data section is used.
6947
6948This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
6949@end defmac
6950
6951@hook TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS
6952Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
6953@file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
6954of its own that you need to create.
6955
6956GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
6957any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
6958described below.
6959@end deftypefn
6960
6961@hook TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK
6962Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
6963selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
6964should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
6965local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
6966
6967The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
6968is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
6969when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
6970in read-only sections even in executables.
6971@end deftypefn
6972
6973@hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION
6974Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
6975assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
6976some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
6977requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
6978local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
6979@var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
6980
6981The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
6982variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
6983
6984See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
6985@end deftypefn
6986
6987@defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
6988Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
6989for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
6990
6991In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
6992function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
6993it is unlikely to be called.
6994@end defmac
6995
6996@hook TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION
6997Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
6998and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
6999As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
7000the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
7001
7002The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
7003ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
7004example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
7005Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7006@end deftypefn
7007
7008@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION
7009Return the readonly data section associated with
7010@samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7011The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7012the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7013if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7014otherwise.
7015@end deftypefn
7016
7017@hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION
7018Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7019should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7020constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7021case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7022in bits.
7023
7024The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7025constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7026else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7027@end deftypefn
7028
7029@hook TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME
7030Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7031by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7032the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7033or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7034hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7035your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7036returns the @var{id} provided.
7037@end deftypefn
7038
7039@hook TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO
7040Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7041treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7042function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7043
7044The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7045@var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7046an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7047rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7048in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7049
7050In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7051a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7052will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7053register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7054rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7055leave it alone.)
7056
7057The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7058that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7059be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7060declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7061declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7062@var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7063
7064@cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7065The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7066@code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7067Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7068encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7069discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7070
7071The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7072in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7073@code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7074before overriding it.
7075@end deftypefn
7076
7077@hook TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING
7078Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7079the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7080may have added.
7081@end deftypefn
7082
7083@hook TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P
7084Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7085The default version of this hook always returns false.
7086@end deftypefn
7087
7088@hook TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7089Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7090``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7091@end deftypevr
7092
3c5273a9
KT
7093@hook TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
7094
38f8b050
JR
7095@hook TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P
7096Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7097rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7098or executable image).
7099
7100The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7101for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7102currently supported object file formats.
7103@end deftypefn
7104
7105@hook TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7106Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7107The default value is false.
7108@end deftypevr
7109
7110
7111@node PIC
7112@section Position Independent Code
7113@cindex position independent code
7114@cindex PIC
7115
7116This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7117independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7118generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7119@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7120@code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7121must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7122when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7123need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7124relative addresses.
7125@c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
7126@c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7127
7128@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7129The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7130data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7131processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7132is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7133pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7134is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7135necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7136when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7137@end defmac
7138
7139@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
f8fe0a4a
JM
7140A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7141@code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7142the default is zero. Do not define
38f8b050
JR
7143this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7144@end defmac
7145
7146@defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7147A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7148operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7149You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7150check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7151check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7152(including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7153position independent code.
7154@end defmac
7155
7156@node Assembler Format
7157@section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7158
7159This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7160to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7161instructions do.
7162
7163@menu
7164* File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7165* Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7166* Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7167* Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7168* Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7169 and termination routines.
7170* Macros for Initialization::
7171 Specific macros that control the handling of
7172 initialization and termination routines.
7173* Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7174* Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7175* Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7176* Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7177@end menu
7178
7179@node File Framework
7180@subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7181@cindex assembler format
7182@cindex output of assembler code
7183
7184@c prevent bad page break with this line
7185This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7186
7187@findex default_file_start
7188@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START
7189Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7190find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7191by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7192quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7193@code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7194lets other target files rely on these variables.
7195@end deftypefn
7196
7197@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7198If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7199printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7200@option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7201to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7202definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7203assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7204whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7205
7206The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7207verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7208comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7209@end deftypevr
7210
7211@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7212If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7213for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7214@code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7215this to be done. The default is false.
7216@end deftypevr
7217
7218@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_END
7219Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7220to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7221@end deftypefn
7222
7223@deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7224Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7225special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7226the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7227should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7228need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7229this function.
7230@end deftypefun
7231
7232@hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_START
7233Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7234to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7235nothing.
7236@end deftypefn
7237
7238@hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_END
7239Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7240to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7241nothing.
7242@end deftypefn
7243
7244@hook TARGET_ASM_CODE_END
7245Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7246unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7247here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7248because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7249nothing.
7250@end deftypefn
7251
7252@defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7253A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7254assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7255the end of the line.
7256@end defmac
7257
7258@defmac ASM_APP_ON
7259A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7260statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7261@code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7262assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7263that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7264@end defmac
7265
7266@defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7267A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7268statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7269@code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7270time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7271@end defmac
7272
7273@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7274A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7275which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7276the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7277
7278This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7279for the file format in use is appropriate.
7280@end defmac
7281
b5f5d41d
AS
7282@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
7283
38f8b050
JR
7284@defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7285A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7286@var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7287in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7288the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7289of the filename using this macro.
7290@end defmac
7291
7292@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7293A C statement to output something to the assembler file to handle a
7294@samp{#ident} directive containing the text @var{string}. If this
7295macro is not defined, nothing is output for a @samp{#ident} directive.
7296@end defmac
7297
7298@hook TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION
7299Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7300should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7301of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7302is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7303this section is associated.
7304@end deftypefn
7305
7306@hook TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7307This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
7308@end deftypevr
7309
7310@anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7311@hook TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7312This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7313section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7314This is true on most ELF targets.
7315@end deftypevr
7316
7317@hook TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS
7318Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7319based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7320declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
7321null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7322
7323The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7324read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7325need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7326set via @code{__attribute__}.
7327@end deftypefn
7328
7329@hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES
7330Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7331switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7332enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7333It can take the following values:
7334
7335@table @gcctabopt
7336@item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7337@var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7338
7339@item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7340@var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7341direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7342default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7343command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7344various different individual optimization passes.
7345
7346@item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7347@var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7348ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7349target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7350time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7351warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7352wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7353necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7354perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7355switches.
7356
7357@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7358This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7359
7360@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7361This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7362@end table
7363
7364The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7365supported in the future.
7366
7367By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7368provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7369it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7370section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7371provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7372hook.
7373@end deftypefn
7374
7375@hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7376This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7377ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7378hook.
7379@end deftypevr
7380
7381@need 2000
7382@node Data Output
7383@subsection Output of Data
7384
7385
7386@hook TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7387@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7388@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7389@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7390@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7391@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7392@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7393@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7394@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7395These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7396of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7397byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7398aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7399@code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7400
7401The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7402followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7403the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7404@end deftypevr
7405
7406@hook TARGET_ASM_INTEGER
7407The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7408integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7409in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7410function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7411object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7412split the object into smaller parts.
7413
7414The default implementation of this hook will use the
7415@code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7416when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7417@end deftypefn
7418
6cbd8875
AS
7419@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA
7420A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7421can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7422the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7423@code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7424
7425If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7426so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7427itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7428return @code{true}.
7429@end deftypefn
7430
38f8b050
JR
7431@defmac OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{fail})
7432A C statement to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that
7433@code{output_addr_const} can't deal with, and output assembly code to
7434@var{stream} corresponding to the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to
7435allow machine-dependent @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7436
7437If @code{OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA} fails to recognize a pattern, it must
7438@code{goto fail}, so that a standard error message is printed. If it
7439prints an error message itself, by calling, for example,
7440@code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just complete normally.
7441@end defmac
7442
7443@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7444A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7445instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7446bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7447@code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7448
7449If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7450Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7451@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7452@end defmac
7453
7454@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7455A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7456@var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7457is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7458@end defmac
7459
7460@defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7461You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
7462expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7463pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7464GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7465not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7466pool before the function.
7467@end defmac
7468
7469@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7470A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7471constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7472the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7473be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7474is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7475immediately after this call.
7476
7477If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7478not be defined.
7479@end defmac
7480
7481@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7482A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7483constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7484anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7485
7486The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7487assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7488output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7489@samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7490@var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7491alignment.
7492
7493The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7494the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7495responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7496Here is how to do this:
7497
7498@smallexample
7499@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7500@end smallexample
7501
7502When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7503@code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7504entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7505
7506You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7507@end defmac
7508
7509@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7510A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7511pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7512function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7513obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7514constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7515
7516If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7517define this macro.
7518@end defmac
7519
7520@defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7521Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7522used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7523to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7524a line separator uses multiple characters.
7525
7526If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7527the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7528@end defmac
7529
7530@hook TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7531These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7532assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7533default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7534@end deftypevr
7535
7536These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7537of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7538
7539@defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7540@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7541@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7542@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7543@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7544@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7545These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7546target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7547the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7548@code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7549simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7550@code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7551by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7552it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
755332 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7554on the host machine.
7555
7556The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7557using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7558machine's memory.
7559@end defmac
7560
7561@node Uninitialized Data
7562@subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7563
7564Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7565outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7566
7567@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7568A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7569@var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7570@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7571is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7572possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7573other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7574backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7575byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7576equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7577the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7578an ordinary undefined external.
7579
7580Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7581output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7582assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7583
7584This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7585common global variables are output.
7586@end defmac
7587
7588@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7589Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7590separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7591place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7592handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7593as the number of bits.
7594@end defmac
7595
7596@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7597Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7598variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7599is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7600in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7601@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7602the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7603@end defmac
7604
7605@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7606A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7607@var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
7608@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7609is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7610
7611Try to use function @code{asm_output_bss} defined in @file{varasm.c} when
7612defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
7613@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7614before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7615the name, and a newline.
7616
7617There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define either
7618this macro or its aligned counterpart, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS}.
7619The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7620switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7621You do not need to do both.
7622
7623Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7624non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7625efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7626not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7627common in order to save space in the object file.
7628@end defmac
7629
7630@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7631Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} except takes the required alignment as a
7632separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7633place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}, and gives you more flexibility in
7634handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7635as the number of bits.
7636
7637Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7638@file{varasm.c} when defining this macro.
7639@end defmac
7640
7641@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7642A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7643@var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7644@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7645is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7646
7647Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7648output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7649assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7650
7651This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7652static variables are output.
7653@end defmac
7654
7655@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7656Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7657separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7658place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7659handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7660as the number of bits.
7661@end defmac
7662
7663@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7664Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7665variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7666is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7667in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7668@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7669the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7670@end defmac
7671
7672@node Label Output
7673@subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7674
7675@c prevent bad page break with this line
7676This is about outputting labels.
7677
7678@findex assemble_name
7679@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7680A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7681@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7682Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7683output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7684assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7685definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7686@end defmac
7687
135a687e
KT
7688@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7689A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7690@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7691a function.
7692Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7693output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7694assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7695definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7696
7697If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7698usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7699@end defmac
7700
38f8b050
JR
7701@findex assemble_name_raw
7702@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7703Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
7704to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7705@code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7706that it is more efficient.
7707@end defmac
7708
7709@defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
7710A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7711size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7712default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7713systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7714
7715Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7716of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7717for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7718macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7719define this macro.
7720@end defmac
7721
7722@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
7723A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7724@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7725symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7726If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7727provided.
7728@end defmac
7729
7730@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7731A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7732@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
7733the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
7734address.
7735
7736If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7737provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7738@samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7739the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7740not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7741to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
7742@end defmac
7743
7744@defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
7745A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7746type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7747default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7748systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7749
7750Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7751@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7752custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7753types at all, do not define this macro.
7754@end defmac
7755
7756@defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
7757A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7758the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
7759default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7760the default is not to define this macro.
7761
7762Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7763@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7764custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7765types at all, do not define this macro.
7766@end defmac
7767
7768@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7769A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7770@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7771symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7772that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7773you should not count on this.
7774
7775If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7776definition of this macro is provided.
7777@end defmac
7778
7779@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7780A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7781@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7782function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
7783outputting the label definition (perhaps using
135a687e 7784@code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
38f8b050
JR
7785@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7786
7787If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
135a687e 7788usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
38f8b050
JR
7789
7790You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7791of this macro.
7792@end defmac
7793
7794@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7795A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7796@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7797which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7798function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7799representing the function.
7800
7801If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7802
7803You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7804of this macro.
7805@end defmac
7806
7807@defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7808A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7809@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7810initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
7811label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
7812@var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7813
7814If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7815usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7816
7817You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7818@code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
7819@end defmac
7820
ad78130c 7821@hook TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME
38f8b050
JR
7822A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
7823for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
7824target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7825@code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
7826and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
7827will be an internal label.
7828
7829The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
7830usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
7831
7832You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
7833@end deftypefn
7834
7835@defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
7836A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7837@var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7838for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
7839
7840If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7841nothing.
7842@end defmac
7843
7844@defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
7845A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
7846once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
7847chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
7848initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
7849something about the size of the object.
7850
7851If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7852nothing.
7853
7854You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7855@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
7856@end defmac
7857
7858@hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL
7859This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7860@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
7861that is, available for reference from other files.
7862
7863The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
7864@code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
7865@end deftypefn
7866
7867@hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME
7868This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7869@var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
7870global; that is, available for reference from other files.
7871
7872The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
7873@end deftypefn
7874
7875@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7876A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7877@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
7878that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
7879no other definition is available. Use the expression
7880@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
7881itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
7882for making that name weak, and a newline.
7883
7884If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
7885support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
7886macro.
7887@end defmac
7888
7889@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7890Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
7891@code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
7892or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
7893should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
7894defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
7895@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
7896to make @var{name} weak.
7897@end defmac
7898
7899@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7900Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
7901symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
7902declaration of @code{name}.
7903@end defmac
7904
7905@defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
74b90fe2
JDA
7906A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
7907supports weak symbols.
38f8b050
JR
7908
7909If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7910definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
74b90fe2
JDA
7911is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
7912@end defmac
7913
7914@defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
7915A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
7916
7917If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7918definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
7919this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
7920flag such as @option{-melf}.
38f8b050
JR
7921@end defmac
7922
7923@defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
7924A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
7925public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
7926be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
7927format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
7928section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
7929requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
7930@end defmac
7931
7932@defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
7933A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
7934semantics.
7935
7936If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
7937definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
7938definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
7939you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
7940setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
7941be emitted as one-only.
7942@end defmac
7943
7944@hook TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY
7945This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
7946commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
7947hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
7948@end deftypefn
7949
7950@defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
7951A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
7952that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
7953The default is @code{0}.
7954
7955Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
7956if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
7957will have undefined references from other translation units, that
7958symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
7959thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
7960(explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
7961with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
7962
7963The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
7964targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
7965restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
7966table of contents.
7967@end defmac
7968
7969@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
7970A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7971@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
7972symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
7973not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
7974declaration.
7975
7976This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
7977The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
7978@end defmac
7979
7980@hook TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL
7981This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
7982pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
7983library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
7984@end deftypefn
7985
7986@hook TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED
7987This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
7988directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
7989.no_dead_code_strip directive.
7990@end deftypefn
7991
7992@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7993A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7994@var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
7995@var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
7996is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
7997systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
7998@end defmac
7999
8000@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
8001A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
8002@code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
8003will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
8004to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
8005encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
8006@end defmac
8007
8008@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
8009A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
8010result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
8011@code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8012This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8013specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
8014when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8015being taken.
8016@end defmac
8017
8018@hook TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL
8019A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8020name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
8021
8022It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8023used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8024will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8025
8026It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8027object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8028should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8029beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8030convention your system uses, and follow it.
8031
8032The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
8033@end deftypefn
8034
8035@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8036A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8037label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8038@var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8039may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8040systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8041bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8042bundles.
8043
8044If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8045used.
8046@end defmac
8047
8048@defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8049A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8050is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8051
8052This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8053produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8054with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8055
8056If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8057output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8058@code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8059string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8060to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8061@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8062you should know what it does on your machine.)
8063@end defmac
8064
8065@defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8066A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8067@code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8068@var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8069added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8070
8071The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8072produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8073@var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8074assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8075macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8076internal static variables in different scopes.
8077
8078Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8079conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8080or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8081between the name and the number will suffice.
8082
8083If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8084which is correct for most systems.
8085@end defmac
8086
8087@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8088A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8089which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8090
8091@findex SET_ASM_OP
8092If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8093correct for most systems.
8094@end defmac
8095
8096@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8097A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8098which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8099to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8100be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8101the tree nodes are available.
8102
8103@findex SET_ASM_OP
8104If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8105correct for most systems.
8106@end defmac
8107
8108@defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8109A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8110(equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8111of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8112current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8113This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8114@samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8115@end defmac
8116
8117@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8118A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8119which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8120@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8121an undefined weak symbol.
8122
8123Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8124@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8125@end defmac
8126
8127@defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8128Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8129Objective-C methods.
8130
8131The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8132class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8133the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8134@samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8135
8136These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8137the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8138systems define other ways of computing names.
8139
8140@var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8141buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8142@var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
814350 characters extra.
8144
8145The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8146method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8147@var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8148in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8149
8150On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8151macro to provide more human-readable names.
8152@end defmac
8153
8154@defmac ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8155A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8156@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8157Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets whose
8158linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8159@end defmac
8160
8161@defmac ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8162A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8163@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8164unresolved Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets
8165whose linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8166@end defmac
8167
8168@node Initialization
8169@subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8170@cindex initialization routines
8171@cindex termination routines
8172@cindex constructors, output of
8173@cindex destructors, output of
8174
8175The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8176(also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8177data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8178to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8179@code{main} is called.
8180
8181Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8182@dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8183terminates.
8184
8185To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8186must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8187be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8188system, you need to specify how to do this.
8189
8190There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8191initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8192Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8193
8194@findex __CTOR_LIST__
8195@findex __DTOR_LIST__
8196The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8197initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8198termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8199
8200Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
82010, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8202the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8203pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8204pointer containing zero.
8205
8206Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8207@file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8208time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8209list; destructors in forward order.
8210
8211The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8212formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8213aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8214Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8215object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8216the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8217accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8218Termination functions are handled similarly.
8219
8220This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8221@code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8222support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8223constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8224and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8225
8226When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8227upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8228support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8229parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8230program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8231
8232@smallexample
8233ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8234@end smallexample
8235
8236The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8237section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8238for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8239files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8240are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8241
8242The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8243compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8244fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8245to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8246of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8247that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8248
8249To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8250macro properly.
8251
8252If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8253@code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8254entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8255it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8256after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8257in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8258
8259In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8260two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8261and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
8262@code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8263entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8264and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8265code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8266the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8267placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8268a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8269@code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
8270section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8271the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8272the initialization process.
8273
8274The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8275This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8276file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
8277this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8278termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8279an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8280pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8281the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8282initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8283via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8284@code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8285
8286@ifinfo
8287The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8288customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8289@end ifinfo
8290
8291@node Macros for Initialization
8292@subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8293
8294Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8295and termination functions:
8296
8297@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8298If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8299operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8300defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8301using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8302macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8303run the initialization functions.
8304@end defmac
8305
8306@defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8307If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8308This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8309on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8310be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8311@end defmac
8312
8313@defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8314If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8315the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8316@end defmac
8317
8318@defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8319If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8320the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8321@end defmac
8322
8323@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8324If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8325automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8326should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8327the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8328function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8329
8330This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8331shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8332exception tables embedded in the code.
8333@end defmac
8334
8335@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8336If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8337automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8338should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8339the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8340function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8341@end defmac
8342
8343@defmac INVOKE__main
8344If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8345@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8346where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8347useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8348@end defmac
8349
8350@defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8351If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8352compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8353of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8354encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8355@end defmac
8356
8357@hook TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8358This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8359collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8360It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8361@end deftypevr
8362
8363@hook TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR
8364If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8365the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8366
8367Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8368no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8369priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8370otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8371
8372If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8373be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8374target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8375is not defined.
8376@end deftypefn
8377
8378@hook TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR
8379This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8380functions rather than initialization functions.
8381@end deftypefn
8382
8383If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8384generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8385
8386If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8387constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8388an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8389
8390On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8391@command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8392
8393@defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8394Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8395object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8396object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8397
8398This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8399part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8400@end defmac
8401
8402@defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8403Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8404to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8405@command{nm}.
3e794bfe
RO
8406@end defmac
8407
8408@defmac NM_FLAGS
8409@command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8410constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
8411passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
8412are needed to get the same output formut as GNU @command{nm -n}
8413produces.
8414@end defmac
38f8b050
JR
8415
8416If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8417dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8418these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8419termination functions in shared libraries:
38f8b050
JR
8420
8421@defmac LDD_SUFFIX
8422Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
3e794bfe 8423which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
38f8b050
JR
8424@end defmac
8425
8426@defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8427Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8428of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
8429of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8430from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8431code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8432line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8433@end defmac
8434
8435@defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8436Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8437library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8438strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8439constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8440that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8441@end defmac
8442
8443@node Instruction Output
8444@subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8445
8446@c prevent bad page break with this line
8447This describes assembler instruction output.
8448
8449@defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8450A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8451registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8452register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8453@end defmac
8454
8455@defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8456If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8457and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8458registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8459to registers using alternate names.
8460@end defmac
8461
0c6d290e
RE
8462@defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
8463If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
8464name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
8465machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
8466names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
8467declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
8468@code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
8469register name implies multiple underlying registers.
8470
8471This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
8472@code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
8473register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
8474VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
8475``s0'' and ``s1''.
8476@end defmac
8477
38f8b050
JR
8478@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8479Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8480requires different names for the machine instructions.
8481
8482The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8483assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8484macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8485points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8486written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8487opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8488increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8489so that it will not be output twice.
8490
8491In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8492name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8493that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8494care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8495@var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8496
8497@findex recog_data.operand
8498If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8499elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8500
8501If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8502in the usual way.
8503@end defmac
8504
8505@defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8506If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8507assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8508they will be output differently.
8509
8510Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8511extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8512elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8513The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8514template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8515by changing the contents of the vector.
8516
8517This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8518file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8519can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8520as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8521syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8522writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8523
8524If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8525@end defmac
8526
8527@hook TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN
8528If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8529output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8530if necessary.
8531
8532Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8533extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8534elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8535The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8536template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8537by checking the contents of the vector.
8538@end deftypefn
8539
8540@defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8541A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8542assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8543RTL expression.
8544
8545@var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8546of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8547printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8548the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8549operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8550@var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8551@var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8552
8553@findex reg_names
8554If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8555The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8556@code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8557@code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8558
8559When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8560(a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8561with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8562@var{code}.
8563@end defmac
8564
8565@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8566A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8567punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8568@code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8569punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8570in this way.
8571@end defmac
8572
8573@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
8574A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8575assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8576whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8577
8578@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
8579On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
8580section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8581@code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
8582@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8583Format}.
8584@end defmac
8585
8586@findex dbr_sequence_length
8587@defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
8588A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8589been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8590determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8591currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8592or whatever.
8593
8594Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8595reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
8596explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
8597@end defmac
8598
8599@findex final_sequence
8600Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
8601prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8602(i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
8603found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8604processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8605being output.
8606
8607@findex asm_fprintf
8608@defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8609@defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8610@defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8611@defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
8612If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8613@samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8614@file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8615support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8616files can define these macros differently.
8617@end defmac
8618
8619@defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
8620If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
8621statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8622the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8623printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
8624statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
8625generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8626specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8627The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8628string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8629upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
8630@end defmac
8631
8632@defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
8633If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8634different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8635numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8636first variant.
8637
8638If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
8639@smallexample
8640@samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
8641@end smallexample
8642@noindent
8643in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8644first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8645@samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8646@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8647within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8648alternatives within the braces than the value of
8649@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
8650
8651If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8652@samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8653operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8654
8655Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8656@code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
8657the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
8658@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8659if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8660opcodes or operand order.
8661@end defmac
8662
8663@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8664A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8665which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8666The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8667profiling.
8668@end defmac
8669
8670@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8671A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8672which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8673The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8674profiling.
8675@end defmac
8676
8677@node Dispatch Tables
8678@subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8679
8680@c prevent bad page break with this line
8681This concerns dispatch tables.
8682
8683@cindex dispatch table
8684@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
8685A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8686pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8687@var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8688definitions of these labels are output using
8689@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
8690way here. For example,
8691
8692@smallexample
8693fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8694 @var{value}, @var{rel})
8695@end smallexample
8696
8697You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
8698dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
8699will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
8700@var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
8701mode and flags can be read.
8702@end defmac
8703
8704@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
8705This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8706in a dispatch table are absolute.
8707
8708The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8709@var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8710a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
8711definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8712For example,
8713
8714@smallexample
8715fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
8716@end smallexample
8717@end defmac
8718
8719@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8720Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8721specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
8722@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
8723jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
8724@code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8725
8726This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8727for the table.
8728
8729If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
8730@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8731@end defmac
8732
8733@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8734Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8735jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8736after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
8737the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
8738@var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8739of the preceding label.
8740
8741If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8742the jump-table.
8743@end defmac
8744
8745@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL
8746This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
8747should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8748should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8749function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
8750The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8751exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8752true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
8753
8754The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8755@end deftypefn
8756
8757@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL
8758This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8759It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8760to be broken up according to function.
8761
8762The default is that no label is emitted.
8763@end deftypefn
8764
a68b5e52
RH
8765@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY
8766
38f8b050
JR
8767@hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT
8768This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
f0a0390e
RH
8769given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
8770returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
38f8b050
JR
8771@end deftypefn
8772
3bc6b3e6
RH
8773@hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
8774
38f8b050
JR
8775@node Exception Region Output
8776@subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
8777
8778@c prevent bad page break with this line
8779
8780This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
8781region.
8782
8783@defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
8784If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
8785exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
8786provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
8787@file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
8788
8789You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
8790unwind information and the default definition does not work.
8791@end defmac
8792
8793@defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
8794If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
8795data section even though the target supports named sections. This
8796might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
8797collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
8798
8799Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
8800also defined.
8801@end defmac
8802
8803@defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
8804Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
8805information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
8806runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
8807and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
8808@end defmac
8809
8810@defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
8811An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
8812that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
8813@end defmac
8814
8815@defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
8816Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8817information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
8818Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
f0a0390e
RH
8819@code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either @code{UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP}
8820or @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}), GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
8821@end defmac
38f8b050 8822
f0a0390e
RH
8823@hook TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO
8824This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
8825by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
8826should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
8827@code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
8828should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8829information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
38f8b050 8830
f0a0390e
RH
8831A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
8832This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
8833default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
38f8b050 8834
f0a0390e
RH
8835Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
8836not depend on anything except command-line switches. In particular, the
8837setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
8838macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
8839depending on this setting.
8840
8841The default implementation of the hook first honors the
8842@option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
8843@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}.
8844@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8845
8846@hook TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
8847This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
8848tables even when exceptions are not used.
8849@end deftypevr
8850
8851@defmac MUST_USE_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS
8852This macro need only be defined if @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} is
8853runtime-variable. In that case, @file{except.h} cannot correctly
8854determine the corresponding definition of @code{MUST_USE_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS},
8855so the target must provide it directly.
8856@end defmac
8857
8858@defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
8859Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
8860should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
8861instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
8862@end defmac
8863
8864@defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
8865This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
8866function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
8867@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
8868alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
8869minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
8870the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
8871@end defmac
8872
8873@hook TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
8874Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
8875end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
8876Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
8877true otherwise.
8878@end deftypevr
8879
8880@hook TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN
8881Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
8882represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
8883register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
8884locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
8885register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8886If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8887@end deftypefn
8888
8889@hook TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA
8890If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
8891multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
8892sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
8893It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
8894filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
8895@var{address} is the address of the table.
8896@end deftypefn
8897
8898@hook TARGET_ASM_TTYPE
8899This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
8900the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
8901if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
8902reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
8903@end deftypefn
8904
8905@hook TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
8906This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
8907based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
8908the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
8909running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
8910@end deftypevr
8911
8912@node Alignment Output
8913@subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
8914
8915@c prevent bad page break with this line
8916This describes commands for alignment.
8917
8918@defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8919The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
8920a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
8921
8922This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8923to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8924define the macro.
8925
8926Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8927to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
8928@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8929selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
8930@end defmac
8931
ad0c4c36
DD
8932@hook TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8933The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
8934@code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
8935@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8936@end deftypefn
8937
38f8b050
JR
8938@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
8939The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8940a @code{BARRIER}.
8941
8942This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8943to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8944define the macro.
8945@end defmac
8946
ad0c4c36
DD
8947@hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
8948The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
38f8b050
JR
8949@code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
8950@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
ad0c4c36 8951@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8952
8953@defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8954The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8955a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
8956
8957This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8958to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8959define the macro.
8960
8961Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8962to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
8963@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8964selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
8965@end defmac
8966
ad0c4c36
DD
8967@hook TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8968The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
8969@var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
8970defined.
8971@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8972
8973@defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
8974The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
8975If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
8976the maximum of the specified values is used.
8977
8978Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8979to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
8980@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8981selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
8982@end defmac
8983
ad0c4c36
DD
8984@hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8985The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
8986to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
8987is defined.
8988@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8989
8990@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
8991A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8992instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
8993Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
8994expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
8995@end defmac
8996
8997@defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
8998Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
8999text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
9000This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
9001produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
9002section.
9003@end defmac
9004
9005@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9006A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9007command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9008@var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
9009@end defmac
9010
9011@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9012Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
9013for padding, if necessary.
9014@end defmac
9015
9016@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
9017A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9018command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9019@var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9020satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9021a C expression of type @code{int}.
9022@end defmac
9023
9024@need 3000
9025@node Debugging Info
9026@section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9027
9028@c prevent bad page break with this line
9029This describes how to specify debugging information.
9030
9031@menu
9032* All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9033* DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9034* DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9035* File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9036* SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
9037* VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
9038@end menu
9039
9040@node All Debuggers
9041@subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9042
9043@c prevent bad page break with this line
9044These macros affect all debugging formats.
9045
9046@defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9047A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9048register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9049of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9050some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9051versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9052compiler and another for DBX@.
9053
9054If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9055used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9056consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9057Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9058expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9059
9060If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9061does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9062redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9063@end defmac
9064
9065@defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9066A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9067variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9068computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9069gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9070that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9071for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
9072@option{-g} options is used.
9073@end defmac
9074
9075@defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9076A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9077having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9078@var{offset}.
9079@end defmac
9080
9081@defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9082A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9083produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9084this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9085debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9086@code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9087@code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9088
9089When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9090value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9091exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9092value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9093defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9094
9095The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9096user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9097@option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9098@end defmac
9099
9100@node DBX Options
9101@subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9102
9103@c prevent bad page break with this line
9104These are specific options for DBX output.
9105
9106@defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9107Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9108in response to the @option{-g} option.
9109@end defmac
9110
9111@defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9112Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9113in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9114@end defmac
9115
9116@defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9117Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9118GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9119debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9120macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9121if there is any occasion to.
9122@end defmac
9123
9124@defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9125Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9126in the text section.
9127@end defmac
9128
9129@defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9130A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9131use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9132If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9133applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9134@end defmac
9135
9136@defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9137A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9138use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9139value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9140@code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9141information format.
9142@end defmac
9143
9144@defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9145A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9146use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9147name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9148macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9149@end defmac
9150
9151@defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9152Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9153@samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9154describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9155On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9156@end defmac
9157
9158@defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9159A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9160continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9161exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9162operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9163must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9164with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9165defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9166@end defmac
9167
9168@defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9169Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9170the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9171a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9172constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9173if backslash is correct for your system.
9174@end defmac
9175
9176@defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9177Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9178outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9179variable.
9180@end defmac
9181
9182@defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9183The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9184for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9185@end defmac
9186
9187@defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9188The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9189for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9190provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9191@end defmac
9192
9193@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9194The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9195for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9196``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9197@end defmac
9198
9199@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9200The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9201passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9202do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9203@end defmac
9204
9205@defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9206Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9207arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9208in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9209code.
9210@end defmac
9211
9212@defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9213Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9214the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9215relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9216an absolute address.
9217@end defmac
9218
9219@defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9220Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9221the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9222start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9223@end defmac
9224
9225@defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9226Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9227@code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9228macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9229number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9230generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9231number for a type number.
9232@end defmac
9233
9234@node DBX Hooks
9235@subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9236
9237@c prevent bad page break with this line
9238These are hooks for DBX format.
9239
9240@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9241Define this macro to say how to output to @var{stream} the debugging
9242information for the start of a scope level for variable names. The
9243argument @var{name} is the name of an assembler symbol (for use with
9244@code{assemble_name}) whose value is the address where the scope begins.
9245@end defmac
9246
9247@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9248Like @code{DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC}, but for the end of a scope level.
9249@end defmac
9250
9251@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NFUN (@var{stream}, @var{lscope_label}, @var{decl})
9252Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
9253output an @code{N_FUN} entry for the function @var{decl}.
9254@end defmac
9255
9256@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9257A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9258number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9259@var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9260invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9261unique labels in the assembly output.
9262
9263This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9264if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9265@end defmac
9266
9267@defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9268Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9269@code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9270On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9271disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9272@end defmac
9273
9274@defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9275Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9276extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9277feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9278@end defmac
9279
9280@node File Names and DBX
9281@subsection File Names in DBX Format
9282
9283@c prevent bad page break with this line
9284This describes file names in DBX format.
9285
9286@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9287A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9288@var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9289file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9290This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9291
9292This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9293for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9294
9295It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9296text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9297to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9298@var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9299@end defmac
9300
9301@defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9302Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9303of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9304the beginning of the file.
9305@end defmac
9306
9307@defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9308Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9309that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9310an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9311@samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9312@end defmac
9313
9314@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9315A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9316compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9317written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9318
9319If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9320of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9321@end defmac
9322
9323@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9324Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9325@code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9326the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9327whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9328@end defmac
9329
9330@need 2000
9331@node SDB and DWARF
9332@subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9333
9334@c prevent bad page break with this line
9335Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9336
9337@defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9338Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9339for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9340@end defmac
9341
9342@defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9343Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9344debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9345
9346@hook TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION
9347Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9348be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9349value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9350@end deftypefn
9351
9352To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9353define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9354@code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9355prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9356as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9357@end defmac
9358
9359@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9360Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
f0a0390e
RH
9361Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9362(@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9363exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9364how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
38f8b050
JR
9365@end defmac
9366
f0a0390e
RH
9367@hook TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO
9368This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9369unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9370@code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9371return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9372
9373A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9374is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9375
9376A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9377This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9378@end deftypefn
9379
38f8b050
JR
9380@defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9381Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9382line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9383tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9384@end defmac
9385
9730bc27
TT
9386@hook TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9387
38f8b050
JR
9388@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9389A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9390@var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9391@end defmac
9392
9393@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9394A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9395between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9396slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9397@end defmac
9398
9399@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
9400A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9401section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9402given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
9403@end defmac
9404
9405@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9406A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9407reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9408@end defmac
9409
9410@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9411A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9412the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9413is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9414is referenced by a function.
9415@end defmac
9416
9417@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL
9418If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9419reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9420@end deftypefn
9421
9422@defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9423Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9424SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9425macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9426not define them yourself.
9427@end defmac
9428
9429@defmac SDB_DELIM
9430Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9431SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9432delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9433a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9434required.
9435@end defmac
9436
9437@defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9438Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9439union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9440allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9441it.
9442@end defmac
9443
9444@defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9445Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9446enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9447assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9448@end defmac
9449
9450@defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9451A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9452number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9453@var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9454@end defmac
9455
9456@need 2000
9457@node VMS Debug
9458@subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9459
9460@c prevent bad page break with this line
9461Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9462
9463@defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9464Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9465in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9466is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9467@option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
fac0f722 9468behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
38f8b050
JR
9469@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9470@end defmac
9471
9472@node Floating Point
9473@section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9474@cindex cross compilation and floating point
9475@cindex floating point and cross compilation
9476
9477While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9478there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9479means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9480in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9481doing the compilation.
9482
9483Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9484range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9485the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9486safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9487the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9488emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9489target floating point formats are identical.
9490
9491The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9492use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9493floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9494their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9495
9496@defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9497The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9498machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9499array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9500quantity.
9501@end defmac
9502
9503@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9504Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
9505floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
9506@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
9507@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
9508@end deftypefn
9509
9510@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9511Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
9512@end deftypefn
9513
9514@deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9515Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9516@end deftypefn
9517
9518@deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9519Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9520@var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9521@end deftypefn
9522
9523@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9524Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9525representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9526decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9527defined by the C language for both.
9528@end deftypefn
9529
9530@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9531Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9532@end deftypefn
9533
9534@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9535Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9536@end deftypefn
9537
9538@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9539Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9540@end deftypefn
9541
9542@deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9543Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
9544@var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
9545variable).
9546
9547The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
9548following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
9549@code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
9550
9551If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
9552target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
9553@code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
9554@code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
9555@end deftypefn
9556
9557@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9558Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9559@end deftypefn
9560
9561@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9562Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9563@end deftypefn
9564
9565@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{x})
9566Truncates the floating point value @var{x} to fit in @var{mode}. The
9567return value is still a full-size @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, but it has an
9568appropriate bit pattern to be output as a floating constant whose
9569precision accords with mode @var{mode}.
9570@end deftypefn
9571
9572@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9573Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
9574which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}. If the value is not
9575integral, it is truncated.
9576@end deftypefn
9577
9578@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9579Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
9580into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}. The
9581value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
9582@end deftypefn
9583
9584@node Mode Switching
9585@section Mode Switching Instructions
9586@cindex mode switching
9587The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9588
9589@defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9590Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9591switching in an optimizing compilation.
9592
9593For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9594floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9595the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9596operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9597purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
9598be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
9599or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9600
9601You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9602which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
9603return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9604If you define this macro, you also have to define
9605@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
9606@code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
9607@code{MODE_AFTER}, @code{MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{MODE_EXIT}
9608are optional.
9609@end defmac
9610
9611@defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9612If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9613initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9614N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9615of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
9616The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9617zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9618entity in question.
9619In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
9620represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9621switch is needed / supplied.
9622@end defmac
9623
9624@defmac MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
9625@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9626@code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
9627return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
9628@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
9629be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
9630@end defmac
9631
9632@defmac MODE_AFTER (@var{mode}, @var{insn})
9633If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during
9634mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if
9635different from the incoming mode).
9636@end defmac
9637
9638@defmac MODE_ENTRY (@var{entity})
9639If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9640mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9641@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{MODE_ENTRY}
9642is defined then @code{MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9643@end defmac
9644
9645@defmac MODE_EXIT (@var{entity})
9646If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9647mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9648@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{MODE_EXIT}
9649is defined then @code{MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9650@end defmac
9651
9652@defmac MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
9653This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
96540 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
9655lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
9656for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
9657(@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
9658@code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9659@end defmac
9660
9661@defmac EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
9662Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
9663@var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
9664the insn(s) are to be inserted.
9665@end defmac
9666
9667@node Target Attributes
9668@section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9669@cindex target attributes
9670@cindex machine attributes
9671@cindex attributes, target-specific
9672
9673Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9674These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9675be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9676
9677@hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9678If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9679attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
9680specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9681entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9682take.
9683@end deftypevr
9684
9685@hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P
9686If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9687machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9688given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9689subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9690false for all machine-specific attributes.
9691@end deftypefn
9692
9693@hook TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9694If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9695@var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9696and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9697generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9698supposed always to be compatible.
9699@end deftypefn
9700
9701@hook TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9702If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
9703the newly defined @var{type}.
9704@end deftypefn
9705
9706@hook TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9707Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9708handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9709@code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9710that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9711function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9712merging.
9713@end deftypefn
9714
9715@hook TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9716Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9717handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9718@code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9719@var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9720when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9721attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9722call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9723
9724@findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9725If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9726for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9727@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9728will then define a function called
9729@code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9730the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9731add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9732to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9733@samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9734@file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
9735@end deftypefn
9736
9737@hook TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P
9738
9739@defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
9740Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
9741@code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9742default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9743@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9744of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9745on this implementation detail.
9746@end defmac
9747
9748@hook TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES
9749Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9750when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9751wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9752the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9753created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9754for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9755shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9756the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9757attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9758needed.
9759@end deftypefn
9760
9761@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P
9762@cindex inlining
9763This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
9764into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9765attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
9766target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9767@end deftypefn
9768
9769@hook TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P
9770This hook is called to parse the @code{attribute(option("..."))}, and
9771it allows the function to set different target machine compile time
9772options for the current function that might be different than the
9773options specified on the command line. The hook should return
9774@code{true} if the options are valid.
9775
9776The hook should set the @var{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9777the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target specific
9778@var{struct cl_target_option} structure.
9779@end deftypefn
9780
9781@hook TARGET_OPTION_SAVE
9782This hook is called to save any additional target specific information
9783in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for function specific
9784options.
9785@xref{Option file format}.
9786@end deftypefn
9787
9788@hook TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE
9789This hook is called to restore any additional target specific
9790information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9791function specific options.
9792@end deftypefn
9793
9794@hook TARGET_OPTION_PRINT
9795This hook is called to print any additional target specific
9796information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9797function specific options.
9798@end deftypefn
9799
56cb42ea 9800@hook TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE
38f8b050
JR
9801This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC option} to
9802set the machine specific options for functions that occur later in the
9803input stream. The options should be the same as handled by the
56cb42ea 9804@code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
38f8b050
JR
9805@end deftypefn
9806
9807@hook TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE
9808Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
9809a particular target machine. You can override the hook
9810@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
9811once just after all the command options have been parsed.
9812
9813Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
fac0f722 9814@option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
38f8b050
JR
9815
9816If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
9817changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
9818@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
9819@end deftypefn
9820
9821@hook TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P
9822This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
9823cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
9824default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
9825specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
9826@end deftypefn
9827
9828@node Emulated TLS
9829@section Emulating TLS
9830@cindex Emulated TLS
9831
9832For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
9833specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
9834used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
9835configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
9836the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
9837layer.
9838
9839The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
9840object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
9841which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
9842address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
9843
9844@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
9845Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
9846object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
9847emulated TLS helper function to be used.
9848@end deftypevr
9849
9850@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
9851Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
9852program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
9853initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
9854have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
9855registration function to be used.
9856@end deftypevr
9857
9858@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
9859Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
9860be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
9861any section.
9862@end deftypevr
9863
9864@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
9865Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
9866placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
9867section.
9868@end deftypevr
9869
9870@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
9871Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
9872The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9873@end deftypevr
9874
9875@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
9876Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
9877default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9878@end deftypevr
9879
9880@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS
9881Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
9882object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
9883@var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
9884@code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
9885for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
9886@end deftypefn
9887
9888@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT
9889Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
9890TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
9891is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
9892initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
9893@end deftypefn
9894
9895@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
9896Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
9897fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
9898single objects. The default is false.
9899@end deftypevr
9900
9901@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
9902Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
9903may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
9904@end deftypevr
9905
9906@node MIPS Coprocessors
9907@section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
9908@cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
9909
9910The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
9911coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
9912accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
9913and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
9914
9915@smallexample
9916 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
9917 unsigned int d;
9918
9919 d = cp0count + 3;
9920@end smallexample
9921
9922(``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
9923names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
9924overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
9925
9926Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
9927be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
9928later in the function.
9929
9930Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
9931the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
9932floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
9933
9934There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
9935you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
9936
9937@defmac ALL_COP_ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
9938A comma-separated list (with leading comma) of pairs describing the
9939alternate names of coprocessor registers. The format of each entry should be
9940@smallexample
9941@{ @var{alternatename}, @var{register_number}@}
9942@end smallexample
9943Default: empty.
9944@end defmac
9945
9946@node PCH Target
9947@section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
9948@cindex parameters, precompiled headers
9949
9950@hook TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY
9951This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
9952@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
9953@samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
9954@end deftypefn
9955
9956@hook TARGET_PCH_VALID_P
9957This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
9958compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
9959if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
9960be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
9961
9962@var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
9963when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
9964It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
9965compiler, so no format checking is needed.
9966
9967The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
9968suitable for most targets.
9969@end deftypefn
9970
9971@hook TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS
9972If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
9973@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
9974of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
9975@code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
9976value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
9977@end deftypefn
9978
9979@node C++ ABI
9980@section C++ ABI parameters
9981@cindex parameters, c++ abi
9982
9983@hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE
9984Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
9985These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
9986default is long_long_integer_type_node.
9987@end deftypefn
9988
9989@hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT
9990This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
9991@code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
9992@code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
9993@end deftypefn
9994
9995@hook TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE
9996This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
9997whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
9998known that a cookie is needed. The default is
9999@code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
10000IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
10001@end deftypefn
10002
10003@hook TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE
10004This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
10005array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
10006@end deftypefn
10007
10008@hook TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS
10009If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
10010class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
10011will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
10012to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
10013modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
10014backend's targeted operating system.
10015@end deftypefn
10016
10017@hook TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS
10018This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
10019the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
10020@code{false}.
10021@end deftypefn
10022
10023@hook TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE
10024This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10025which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10026table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
10027Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10028the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
10029some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10030method. The default is to return @code{true}.
10031@end deftypefn
10032
10033@hook TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY
10034
10035@hook TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT
10036This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10037similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10038external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10039classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10040unit will not be COMDAT.
10041@end deftypefn
10042
10043@hook TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT
10044This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10045the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10046be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10047@end deftypefn
10048
10049@hook TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT
10050This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10051should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10052is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10053@end deftypefn
10054
10055@hook TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT
10056This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10057in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10058destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10059shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10060unloaded. The default is to return false.
10061@end deftypefn
10062
10063@hook TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION
10064
10065@node Named Address Spaces
10066@section Adding support for named address spaces
10067@cindex named address spaces
10068
10069The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10070standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10071support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10072processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10073GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10074address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10075spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10076@code{const} type attributes.
10077
10078Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10079pointers to the generic address space.
10080
10081For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10082to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10083processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10084issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10085local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10086address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10087@option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10088always 32 bits).
10089
10090Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10091range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10092address space.
10093
10094To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10095the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10096the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10097named address space #1:
10098@smallexample
10099#define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10100c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10101@end smallexample
10102
10103@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE
10104Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10105@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10106The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode} for the
10107generic address space only.
10108@end deftypefn
10109
10110@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE
10111Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10112@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10113The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode} for the
10114generic address space only.
10115@end deftypefn
10116
10117@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE
10118Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10119with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10120hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10121except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10122version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10123@code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10124target hooks for the given address space.
10125@end deftypefn
10126
10127@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
10128Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10129@var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10130parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10131finished. This target hook is the same as the
10132@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10133explicit named address space support.
10134@end deftypefn
10135
10136@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
10137Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10138with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10139hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10140except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10141@end deftypefn
10142
10143@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P
10144Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10145contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10146a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10147will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10148arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10149converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10150@end deftypefn
10151
10152@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT
10153Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10154@var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10155space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10156to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10157guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10158as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10159@end deftypefn
10160
10161@node Misc
10162@section Miscellaneous Parameters
10163@cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10164
10165@c prevent bad page break with this line
10166Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10167
10168@defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10169Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10170has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10171conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10172blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10173set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10174to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10175@end defmac
10176
10177@defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10178Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10179has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10180conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10181blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10182set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10183to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10184@end defmac
10185
10186@defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10187An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10188elements of a jump-table should have.
10189@end defmac
10190
10191@defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10192Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10193when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10194it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10195To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10196make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10197The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10198flags can be updated.
10199@end defmac
10200
10201@defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10202Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10203should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10204jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10205contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10206is in effect.
10207@end defmac
10208
10209@hook TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
10210This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10211is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10212The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10213five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10214@end deftypefn
10215
10216@defmac CASE_USE_BIT_TESTS
10217Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate whether C switch
10218statements may be implemented by a sequence of bit tests. This is
10219advantageous on processors that can efficiently implement left shift
10220of 1 by the number of bits held in a register, but inappropriate on
10221targets that would require a loop. By default, this macro returns
10222@code{true} if the target defines an @code{ashlsi3} pattern, and
10223@code{false} otherwise.
10224@end defmac
10225
10226@defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10227Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
10228smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10229Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10230@end defmac
10231
10232@defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10233Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10234memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10235bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10236zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10237of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10238insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10239@code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10240
10241This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10242greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10243value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
10244@code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10245define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10246
10247You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10248the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10249of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10250when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10251integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10252
10253You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10254mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10255@code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10256is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10257@end defmac
10258
10259@defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10260Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10261extends.
10262@end defmac
10263
10264@defmac FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
10265Define this macro if the same instructions that convert a floating
10266point number to a signed fixed point number also convert validly to an
10267unsigned one.
10268@end defmac
10269
10270@hook TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL
10271When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10272divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10273the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10274that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10275of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10276has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10277@end deftypefn
10278
10279@defmac MOVE_MAX
10280The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10281between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10282@end defmac
10283
10284@defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10285The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10286between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10287is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10288constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10289at run-time.
10290@end defmac
10291
10292@defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10293A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10294actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10295of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
10296this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10297a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10298truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
10299instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10300include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10301also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10302arguments to bit-field instructions.
10303
10304If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10305position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10306instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10307
10308However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10309only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10310bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10311such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10312the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10313
10314You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10315@end defmac
10316
10317@anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10318@hook TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK
10319This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10320deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10321@xref{shift patterns}.
10322
10323On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10324shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10325equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10326this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10327otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10328particular behavior is guaranteed.
10329
10330Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10331@emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10332that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10333
10334The default implementation of this function returns
10335@code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10336and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10337@code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10338nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10339by overriding it.
10340@end deftypefn
10341
10342@defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10343A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10344``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10345bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10346operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10347
10348On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10349
10350@c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10351@c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10352When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10353modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10354If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10355such cases may improve things.
10356@end defmac
10357
10358@hook TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED
10359The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10360are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10361@code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10362sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10363otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10364representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10365@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10366@code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
10367@var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10368widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10369
10370Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10371value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10372as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10373@code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10374
10375Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10376describe two related properties. If you define
10377@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10378to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10379extension.
10380
10381In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10382@code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10383@code{mode}.
10384@end deftypefn
10385
10386@defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10387A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10388with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10389(@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10390apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10391comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10392
10393A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10394comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10395and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10396which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10397true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10398operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10399@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10400@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10401the compiler.
10402
10403If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10404generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10405replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10406the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10407For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10408@code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10409@samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10410expression
10411
10412@smallexample
10413(ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10414@end smallexample
10415
10416@noindent
10417can be converted to
10418
10419@smallexample
10420(ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10421@end smallexample
10422
10423@noindent
10424where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10425tested into the sign bit.
10426
10427There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10428for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10429but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
10430are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10431perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10432comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10433
10434Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10435from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10436choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10437to be used:
10438
10439@itemize @bullet
10440@item
10441Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10442@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10443``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10444comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10445combine the normalization with other operations.
10446
10447@item
10448For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10449slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10450other machines.
10451
10452@item
10453As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10454exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10455others.
10456
10457@item
10458Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10459@end itemize
10460
10461Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10462@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10463instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10464those cases, e.g., one matching
10465
10466@smallexample
10467(set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10468@end smallexample
10469
10470Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10471condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10472@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
10473machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10474and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10475@code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
10476@file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptizer can be used to
10477find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10478
10479If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10480not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10481instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10482@end defmac
10483
10484@defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10485A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10486returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10487Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10488floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10489this macro.
10490@end defmac
10491
10492@defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10493A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10494for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10495mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10496this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10497return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10498this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10499@code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10500the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10501given mode.
10502@end defmac
10503
10504@defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10505@defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10506A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
10507for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
10508A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10509If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10510evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10511entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
10512the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
10513In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
10514this value.
10515
10516If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10517@code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10518
10519This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10520relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
10521is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10522to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10523
10524Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10525and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10526visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10527to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10528breaking the API@.
10529@end defmac
10530
10531@defmac Pmode
10532An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10533this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10534pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10535On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10536modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10537
10538The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10539@code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10540@code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10541to @code{Pmode}.
10542@end defmac
10543
10544@defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10545An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10546being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
10547where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
10548@code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10549size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10550as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10551@end defmac
10552
10553@defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10554In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10555constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10556hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10557where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10558strict conformance to the C Standard.
10559
10560Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10561convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10562files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
10563@end defmac
10564
10565@defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
10566Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
10567This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10568C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10569@samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
10570@end defmac
10571
10572@findex #pragma
10573@findex pragma
10574@defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
10575Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
10576If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
10577@code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10578for each pragma. The macro may also do any
10579setup required for the pragmas.
10580
10581The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10582other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
10583definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
10584
10585If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
10586defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
10587
10588Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10589@samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
10590silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
10591@end defmac
10592
10593@deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10594@deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10595
10596Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10597@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
10598@var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10599pragma of the form
10600
10601@smallexample
10602#pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10603@end smallexample
10604
10605@var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10606@code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10607routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
10608on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
10609@var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
10610callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
10611a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10612arguments of pragmas registered with
10613@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10614pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
10615
10616Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
10617compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
10618other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
10619to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
10620building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
10621variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
10622target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
10623the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
10624code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
10625rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10626how to build this object file.
10627@end deftypefun
10628
38f8b050 10629@defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
24a57808 10630Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
38f8b050
JR
10631arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10632@end defmac
10633
10634@hook TARGET_HANDLE_PRAGMA_EXTERN_PREFIX
10635
10636@defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10637If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
10638the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
10639This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
10640@samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10641@end defmac
10642
10643@defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
10644Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
10645identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
10646not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10647there is no need to define this macro in that case.
10648@end defmac
10649
10650@defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
10651Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10652@samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
10653G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
10654@samp{.} is used instead.
10655@end defmac
10656
10657@defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
10658Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10659@samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
10660have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
10661are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
10662@end defmac
10663
10664@defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10665Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10666delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10667even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
10668@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
10669every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10670or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10671you should define this macro.
10672
10673You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10674@end defmac
10675
10676@defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10677Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10678delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10679even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10680@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10681some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10682are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10683define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10684instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10685slot of @var{insn}.
10686
10687You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10688@end defmac
10689
10690@defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
10691Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10692global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10693symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10694instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10695from shared libraries (DLLs).
10696
10697You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
10698@end defmac
10699
10700@hook TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS
10701This target hook should add to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
10702any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for an asm.
10703It should return the result of the last @code{tree_cons} used to add a
10704clobber. The @var{outputs}, @var{inputs} and @var{clobber} lists are the
10705corresponding parameters to the asm and may be inspected to avoid
10706clobbering a register that is an input or output of the asm. You can use
10707@code{tree_overlaps_hard_reg_set}, declared in @file{tree.h}, to test
10708for overlap with regards to asm-declared registers.
10709@end deftypefn
10710
10711@defmac MATH_LIBRARY
10712Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
d9d16a19
JM
10713in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10714@samp{""} if the target does not have a
38f8b050
JR
10715separate math library.
10716
d9d16a19 10717You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
38f8b050
JR
10718@end defmac
10719
10720@defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
10721Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10722specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10723
10724You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10725is wrong.
10726@end defmac
10727
10728@defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10729Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10730functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10731Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
10732to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
10733if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
10734for cross-profiling.
10735@end defmac
10736
10737@defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
10738
10739A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10740conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
10741@code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
107421 if it does use cc0.
10743@end defmac
10744
10745@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10746Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10747conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10748@var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10749contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
10750and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10751then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
10752@var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
10753@end defmac
10754
10755@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10756Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10757if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10758@var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10759being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
10760@end defmac
10761
10762@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
10763A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10764be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
10765a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10766about the currently processed blocks.
10767@end defmac
10768
10769@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
10770A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
10771converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10772can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10773to by @var{ce_info}.
10774@end defmac
10775
10776@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
10777A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
10778converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10779can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10780to by @var{ce_info}.
10781@end defmac
10782
10783@defmac IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS (@var{ce_info})
10784A C expression to initialize any extra fields in a @code{struct ce_if_block}
10785structure, which are defined by the @code{IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10786@end defmac
10787
10788@defmac IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS
10789If defined, it should expand to a set of field declarations that will be
10790added to the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure. These should be initialized
10791by the @code{IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10792@end defmac
10793
10794@hook TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
10795If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
10796instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
10797just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
10798
10799The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
10800it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
10801laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
10802Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
10803
10804You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
10805definition is null.
10806@end deftypefn
10807
10808@hook TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS
10809Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10810that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
10811necessary setup.
10812
10813Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
10814instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
10815they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
10816instructions or prefetch instructions).
10817
10818To create a built-in function, call the function
10819@code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
10820which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
10821up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes} and @code{build_common_tree_nodes_2};
10822only language front ends that use those two functions will call
10823@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
10824@end deftypefn
10825
10826@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL
10827Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10828that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
10829builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
10830If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
10831if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
10832If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
10833@code{error_mark_node}.
10834@end deftypefn
10835
10836@hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN
10837
10838Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10839@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
10840function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
10841convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
10842@var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
10843@var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
10844ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
10845built-in function.
10846@end deftypefn
10847
d66f5459 10848@hook TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN
38f8b050
JR
10849Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
10850was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
10851@emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
10852implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
10853declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
10854arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
10855complete expression that implements the operation, usually
10856another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
10857@var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
10858@end deftypefn
10859
08914aaa 10860@hook TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN
38f8b050
JR
10861Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10862@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
10863built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
10864the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
10865The result is another tree containing a simplified expression for the
10866call's result. If @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
10867@end deftypefn
10868
10869@hook TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP
10870
10871Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
10872low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
10873could not be applied.
10874
10875Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
10876instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
10877the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
10878By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
10879loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
10880@end deftypefn
10881
10882@defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
10883
10884Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
10885Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
10886@var{branch2} is possible.
10887
10888On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
10889filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
10890may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
10891@end defmac
10892
10893@hook TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P
10894This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
10895Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
10896PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
10897of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
10898@end deftypefn
10899
10900@hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE
10901
10902When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
10903register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
10904to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
10905it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
10906is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
10907that had its initial value copied by using
10908@code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
10909Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
10910to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
10911the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
10912@code{MEM}.
10913If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
10914it might decide to use another register anyways.
10915You may use @code{current_function_leaf_function} in the hook, functions
10916that use @code{REG_N_SETS}, to determine if the hard
10917register in question will not be clobbered.
10918The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
10919allocation.
10920@end deftypefn
10921
10922@hook TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P
10923This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
10924@code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
10925this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
10926@code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
10927to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
10928passed along.
10929@end deftypefn
10930
10931@hook TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION
10932The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
10933context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
10934the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
10935per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
10936attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
10937The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
10938and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
10939and is returning to processing at the top level.
10940The default hook function does nothing.
10941
10942GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
10943some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
10944situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
10945or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
10946@code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
10947outside of any function scope.
10948@end deftypefn
10949
10950@defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
10951Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
10952files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
10953use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
10954@end defmac
10955
10956@defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
10957Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
10958automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
10959do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
10960executable files.
10961@end defmac
10962
10963@defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
10964If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
10965specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
10966Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
10967object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
10968lists.
10969@end defmac
10970
10971@defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
10972Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
10973method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
10974must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
10975For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
10976the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
10977defined as this expression:
10978
10979@smallexample
10980build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
10981 build_tree_list
10982 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
10983 NULL))
10984@end smallexample
10985@end defmac
10986
10987@hook TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P
10988This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
10989instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
10990every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
10991reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
10992
10993@smallexample
10994static bool
10995cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
10996@{
10997 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
10998@}
10999@end smallexample
11000@end deftypefn
11001
11002@hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS
11003This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
11004optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
11005usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
11006re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
11007to inter-block scheduling.
11008@end deftypefn
11009
11010@hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED
11011Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
11012registers
11013that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
11014returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
11015that all target registers in the class returned by
11016@samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
11017saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
11018epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
11019true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
11020to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11021to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11022@end deftypefn
11023
11024@hook TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION
11025This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11026This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11027modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11028@end deftypefn
11029
11030@hook TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST
11031This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11032should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11033the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11034the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11035is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11036number of memory accesses.
11037@end deftypefn
11038
11039@defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11040If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11041that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11042that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11043constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11044more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11045system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11046The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11047@end defmac
11048
11049@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11050This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11051target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11052are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11053The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11054@end deftypefn
11055
11056@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11057This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11058target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11059indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11060@var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11061@var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11062@end deftypefn
11063
11064@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11065This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11066The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11067systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11068that are different from @option{-I}.
11069@end deftypefn
11070
11071@defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11072This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11073for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11074@code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11075functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11076@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11077@end defmac
11078
11079@defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11080If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11081target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11082option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11083@end defmac
11084
11085@defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11086If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11087@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11088@end defmac
11089
11090@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11091If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11092target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11093default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11094@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11095@end defmac
11096
11097@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11098If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11099@code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11100@end defmac
11101
11102@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11103If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11104routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11105and scanf formatter settings.
11106@end defmac
11107
11108@hook TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
11109If set to @code{true}, means that the target's memory model does not
11110guarantee that loads which do not depend on one another will access
11111main memory in the order of the instruction stream; if ordering is
11112important, an explicit memory barrier must be used. This is true of
11113many recent processors which implement a policy of ``relaxed,''
11114``weak,'' or ``release'' memory consistency, such as Alpha, PowerPC,
11115and ia64. The default is @code{false}.
11116@end deftypevr
11117
11118@hook TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN
11119If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11120illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11121with prototype @var{typelist}.
11122@end deftypefn
11123
11124@hook TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION
11125If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11126invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11127if validity should be determined by the front end.
11128@end deftypefn
11129
11130@hook TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP
11131If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11132invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11133@code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11134if validity should be determined by the front end.
11135@end deftypefn
11136
11137@hook TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP
11138If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11139invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11140and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11141the front end.
11142@end deftypefn
11143
11144@hook TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE
11145If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11146invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
11147or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11148the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11149@end deftypefn
11150
11151@hook TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE
11152If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11153invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
11154or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11155the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11156@end deftypefn
11157
11158@hook TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE
11159If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11160@var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11161analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11162front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11163target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11164This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11165@end deftypefn
11166
11167@hook TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE
11168If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11169@var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
11170or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
11171This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
11172conversion rules.
11173This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11174@end deftypefn
11175
11176@defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11177This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11178classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11179SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11180@end defmac
11181
11182@defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11183This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11184NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11185@end defmac
11186
11187@defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11188Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
11189to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
11190call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11191and the associated definitions of those functions.
11192@end defmac
11193
11194@hook TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY
11195Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11196necessary.
11197@end deftypefn
11198
11199@hook TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX
11200This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11201different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11202argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11203is needed.
11204@end deftypefn
11205
11206@hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS
11207When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11208arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11209stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11210debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11211@code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11212cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11213to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11214false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11215@end deftypefn
11216
11217@hook TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11218On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11219a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11220is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11221is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11222subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
11223the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11224available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11225constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11226down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11227@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11228accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11229value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11230MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11231@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11232is zero, which disables this optimization. @end deftypevr